blob: 2dfb95435dda9c466133ea1f2c21072af5500668 [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
14#include "Sema.h"
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +000015#include "SemaInit.h"
John McCall5cebab12009-11-18 07:57:50 +000016#include "Lookup.h"
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +000017#include "AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Chris Lattnercb6a3822006-11-10 06:20:45 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Daniel Dunbar6e8aa532008-08-11 05:35:13 +000019#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +000021#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Naroff021ca182008-05-29 21:12:08 +000022#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000023#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +000024#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000025#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000026#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
27#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +000028#include "clang/Parse/DeclSpec.h"
Chris Lattner07d754a2008-10-26 23:43:26 +000029#include "clang/Parse/Designator.h"
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +000030#include "clang/Parse/Scope.h"
Douglas Gregorb53edfb2009-11-10 19:49:08 +000031#include "clang/Parse/Template.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000032using namespace clang;
33
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +000034
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000035/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
36/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
37///
38/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
39/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
40/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
41/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
42/// function is being used.
43///
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000044/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
45/// decls.
46///
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000047/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
48/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000049///
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000050bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000051 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000052 if (D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>()) {
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000053 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, Loc);
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000054 }
55
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000056 // See if the decl is unavailable
57 if (D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
58 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
59 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
60 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +000061
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000062 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000063 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000064 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
65 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
66 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
67 return true;
68 }
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000069 }
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000070
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000071 return false;
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000072}
73
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000074/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000075/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000076/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
77///
78void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000079 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000080 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000081 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000082 return;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000083 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
84 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000085
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +000086 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
87 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000088 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +000089 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
90 int isMethod = 0;
91 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
92 // skip over named parameters.
93 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
94 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
95 if (nullPos)
96 --nullPos;
97 else
98 ++i;
99 }
100 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
101 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000102 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000103 // skip over named parameters.
104 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
105 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
106 if (nullPos)
107 --nullPos;
108 else
109 ++i;
110 }
111 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000112 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000113 // block or function pointer call.
114 QualType Ty = V->getType();
115 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000116 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000117 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
118 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000119 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
120 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
121 unsigned k;
122 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
123 if (nullPos)
124 --nullPos;
125 else
126 ++i;
127 }
128 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
129 }
130 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
131 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000132 } else
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000133 return;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000134 } else
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000135 return;
136
137 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000138 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000139 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000140 return;
141 }
142 int sentinel = i;
143 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
144 --sentinelPos;
145 ++i;
146 }
147 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
148 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000149 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000150 return;
151 }
152 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
153 ++i;
154 ++sentinel;
155 }
156 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
Anders Carlsson0b11a3e2009-11-24 17:24:21 +0000157 if (sentinelExpr && (!isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr) &&
158 (!sentinelExpr->getType()->isPointerType() ||
159 !sentinelExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
160 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)))) {
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000161 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000162 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000163 }
164 return;
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000165}
166
Douglas Gregor87f95b02009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000167SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
168 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
169 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
170}
171
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000172//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
173// Standard Promotions and Conversions
174//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
175
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000176/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
177void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
178 QualType Ty = E->getType();
179 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
180
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000181 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000182 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
Anders Carlsson6904f642009-09-01 20:37:18 +0000183 CastExpr::CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000184 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
185 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
186 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
187 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
188 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
189 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
190 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9321c742008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000191 //
192 // C++ 4.2p1:
193 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
194 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
195 //
196 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
197 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson8fc489d2009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000198 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
199 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000200 }
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000201}
202
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000203void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
204 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000205
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000206 QualType Ty = E->getType();
207 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
208 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
209 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
210 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
211 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
212 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
213 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
214 // rvalue is T
215 //
216 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000217 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
218 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000219 // type of the lvalue.
220 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
221 }
222}
223
224
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000225/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000226/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000227/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
228/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
229/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
230Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
231 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
232 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000233
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000234 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
235 //
236 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
237 // unsigned int may be used:
238 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
239 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
240 // and unsigned int.
241 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
242 //
243 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
244 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
245 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
246 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000247 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
248 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000249 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000250 return Expr;
251 }
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000252 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000253 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000254 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000255 return Expr;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000256 }
257
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000258 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000259 return Expr;
260}
261
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000262/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000263/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000264/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
265void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
266 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
267 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000268
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000269 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000270 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>())
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000271 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000272 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
273 CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000274
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000275 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
276}
277
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000278/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
279/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
280/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
281/// completely illegal.
282bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT) {
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000283 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000284
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000285 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCInterfaceType() &&
286 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
287 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
288 << Expr->getType() << CT))
289 return true;
Douglas Gregor7ca84af2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000290
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000291 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000292 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000293 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
294 << Expr->getType() << CT))
295 return true;
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000296
297 return false;
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000298}
299
300
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000301/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
302/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000303/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000304/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
305/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
306/// GCC.
307QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
308 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000309 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000310 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000311
312 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000313
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000314 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000315 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000316 QualType lhs =
317 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000318 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000319 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000320
321 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
322 if (lhs == rhs)
323 return lhs;
324
325 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
326 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
327 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
328 return lhs;
329
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000330 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000331 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000332 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
333 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000334 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000335 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
336 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
337
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000338 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000339 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000340 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
341 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000342 return destType;
343}
344
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000345//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
346// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
347//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
348
349
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000350/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000351/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
352/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
353/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
354/// string.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000355///
356Action::OwningExprResult
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000357Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000358 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
359
Chris Lattner8a24e582009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000360 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Steve Naroff4f88b312007-03-13 22:37:02 +0000361 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000362 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000363
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +0000364 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000365 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
366 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000367
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000368 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscbad7252008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000369 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000370 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000371
372 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
John McCallc33dec32010-03-15 10:54:44 +0000373 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings )
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000374 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000375
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000376 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
377 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
378 // strings.
379 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerd42c29f2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000380 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000381 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000382
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000383 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000384 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
Chris Lattnerf83b5af2009-02-18 06:40:38 +0000385 Literal.GetStringLength(),
386 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
387 &StringTokLocs[0],
388 StringTokLocs.size()));
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000389}
390
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000391/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
392/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
393/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
394/// for values inside the block or for globals).
395///
Douglas Gregor4f13beb2010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000396/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000397/// up-to-date.
398///
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000399static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000400 ValueDecl *VD) {
401 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
402 // we wanted to.
403 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
404 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000405
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000406 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
407 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
408 return false;
409
410 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
411 // snapshot it.
412 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
413 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000414 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
415 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000416
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000417 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
418 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
419
420 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
421 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
422 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
423 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000424 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
425 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000426
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000427 if (!NextBlock)
428 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000429
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000430 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
431 // having a reference outside it.
432 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
433 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000434
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000435 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
436 // a snapshot as well.
437 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
438 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000439
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000440 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000441}
442
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000443
444
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +0000445/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000446Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallce546572009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000447Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000448 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000449 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
450 Diag(Loc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000451 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000452 << D->getDeclName();
453 return ExprError();
454 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000455
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000456 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
457 if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
458 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
459 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000460 Diag(Loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000461 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000462 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000463 << D->getIdentifier();
464 return ExprError();
465 }
466 }
467 }
468 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000469
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000470 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, D);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000471
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000472 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
473 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
474 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Douglas Gregored6c7442009-11-23 11:41:28 +0000475 D, Loc, Ty));
Douglas Gregorc7acfdf2009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000476}
477
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000478/// getObjectForAnonymousRecordDecl - Retrieve the (unnamed) field or
479/// variable corresponding to the anonymous union or struct whose type
480/// is Record.
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +0000481static Decl *getObjectForAnonymousRecordDecl(ASTContext &Context,
482 RecordDecl *Record) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000483 assert(Record->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000484 "Record must be an anonymous struct or union!");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000485
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +0000486 // FIXME: Once Decls are directly linked together, this will be an O(1)
487 // operation rather than a slow walk through DeclContext's vector (which
488 // itself will be eliminated). DeclGroups might make this even better.
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000489 DeclContext *Ctx = Record->getDeclContext();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000490 for (DeclContext::decl_iterator D = Ctx->decls_begin(),
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +0000491 DEnd = Ctx->decls_end();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000492 D != DEnd; ++D) {
493 if (*D == Record) {
494 // The object for the anonymous struct/union directly
495 // follows its type in the list of declarations.
496 ++D;
497 assert(D != DEnd && "Missing object for anonymous record");
Douglas Gregor6e6ad602009-01-20 01:17:11 +0000498 assert(!cast<NamedDecl>(*D)->getDeclName() && "Decl should be unnamed");
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000499 return *D;
500 }
501 }
502
503 assert(false && "Missing object for anonymous record");
504 return 0;
505}
506
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000507/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
508/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
509/// actual member.
510///
511/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
512/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
513/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
514/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
515/// we found.
516///
517/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
518/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
519/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
520VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
521 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000522 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
523 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
524 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
525
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000526 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000527 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
528 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
529 do {
530 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +0000531 Decl *AnonObject = getObjectForAnonymousRecordDecl(Context, Record);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000532 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000533 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000534 else {
535 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
536 break;
537 }
538 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000539 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000540 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000541
542 return BaseObject;
543}
544
545Sema::OwningExprResult
546Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
547 FieldDecl *Field,
548 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
549 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
550 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000551 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000552 AnonFields);
553
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000554 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
555 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
556 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
557 // found via name lookup.
558 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000559 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000560 if (BaseObject) {
561 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
562 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +0000563 if (BaseObjectExpr) BaseObjectExpr->Destroy(Context);
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000564 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000565 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +0000566 SourceLocation());
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000567 BaseQuals
568 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000569 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
570 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
571 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
572 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
573 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000574 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000575 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
576 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
577 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000578 BaseQuals
579 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000580 } else {
581 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
582 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
583 // program our base object expression is "this".
584 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
585 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000586 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000587 = Context.getTagDeclType(
588 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
589 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000590 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000591 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
592 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
593 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor4b654412009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000594 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000595 MD->getThisType(Context),
596 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000597 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
598 }
599 } else {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000600 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
601 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000602 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000603 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000604 }
605
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000606 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000607 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
608 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000609 }
610
611 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
612 // anonymous struct/union.
613 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000614 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000615 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
616 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
617 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
618 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000619 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
620 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
621
622 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
623 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
624 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
625 ResultQuals.removeConst();
626
627 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
628 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
629
630 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
631 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
632
633 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
634 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
635 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
636
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000637 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000638 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000639 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000640 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
641 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000642 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000643 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000644 }
645
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000646 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000647}
648
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000649/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationName, its location, and
650/// possibly a list of template arguments.
651///
652/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
653/// DecomposeTemplateName.
654///
655/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
656/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
657/// some way.
658static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
659 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
660 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
661 DeclarationName &Name,
662 SourceLocation &NameLoc,
663 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
664 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
665 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
666 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
667
668 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
669 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
670 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
671 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
672 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
673
674 TemplateName TName =
675 Sema::TemplateTy::make(Id.TemplateId->Template).getAsVal<TemplateName>();
676
677 Name = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName);
678 NameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
679 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
680 } else {
681 Name = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
682 NameLoc = Id.StartLocation;
683 TemplateArgs = 0;
684 }
685}
686
687/// Decompose the given template name into a list of lookup results.
688///
689/// The unqualified ID must name a non-dependent template, which can
690/// be more easily tested by checking whether DecomposeUnqualifiedId
691/// found template arguments.
692static void DecomposeTemplateName(LookupResult &R, const UnqualifiedId &Id) {
693 assert(Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId);
694 TemplateName TName =
695 Sema::TemplateTy::make(Id.TemplateId->Template).getAsVal<TemplateName>();
696
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +0000697 if (TemplateDecl *TD = TName.getAsTemplateDecl())
698 R.addDecl(TD);
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +0000699 else if (OverloadedTemplateStorage *OT = TName.getAsOverloadedTemplate())
700 for (OverloadedTemplateStorage::iterator I = OT->begin(), E = OT->end();
701 I != E; ++I)
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +0000702 R.addDecl(*I);
John McCalla9ee3252009-11-22 02:49:43 +0000703
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +0000704 R.resolveKind();
Douglas Gregora121b752009-11-03 16:56:39 +0000705}
706
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000707/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
708/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
709/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000710static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000711 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
712 return false;
713
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000714 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
715 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
716 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
717 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
718 if (!BaseRT) return false;
719
720 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000721 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000722 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
723 return false;
724 }
725
726 return true;
727}
728
John McCallf786fb12009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000729/// Determines whether we can lookup this id-expression now or whether
730/// we have to wait until template instantiation is complete.
731static bool IsDependentIdExpression(Sema &SemaRef, const CXXScopeSpec &SS) {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000732 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000733
John McCallf786fb12009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000734 // If the qualifier scope isn't computable, it's definitely dependent.
735 if (!DC) return true;
736
737 // If the qualifier scope doesn't name a record, we can always look into it.
738 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) return false;
739
740 // We can't look into record types unless they're fully-formed.
741 if (!IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))) return true;
742
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000743 return false;
744}
John McCallf786fb12009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000745
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000746/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
747/// the prospective base classes.
748static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
749 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
750 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000751 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000752 return false;
753
Douglas Gregor0a5a2212010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000754 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000755 if (!RD) return false;
756 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
757
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000758 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
759 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
760 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
761 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
762 if (!BaseRT) return false;
763
764 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000765 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
766 return false;
767 }
768
769 return true;
770}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000771
John McCall5af04502009-12-02 20:26:00 +0000772/// Determines if this is an instance member of a class.
773static bool IsInstanceMember(NamedDecl *D) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000774 assert(D->isCXXClassMember() &&
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000775 "checking whether non-member is instance member");
776
777 if (isa<FieldDecl>(D)) return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000778
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000779 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(D))
780 return !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)->isStatic();
781
782 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)) {
783 D = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)->getTemplatedDecl();
784 return !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)->isStatic();
785 }
786
787 return false;
788}
789
790enum IMAKind {
791 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
792 IMA_Static,
793
794 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
795 IMA_Mixed,
796
797 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
798 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
799 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
800
801 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
802 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
803 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
804
805 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
806 IMA_Instance,
807
808 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
809 IMA_Unresolved,
810
811 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
812 /// context is not an instance method.
813 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
814
815 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
816 /// non-class context.
817 IMA_AnonymousMember,
818
819 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
820 /// context is not an instance method.
821 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
822
823 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
824 /// class.
825 IMA_Error_Unrelated
826};
827
828/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
829/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
830/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
831/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
832/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
833/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
834static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
835 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000836 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000837
838 bool isStaticContext =
839 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext) ||
840 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)->isStatic());
841
842 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
843 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
844
845 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
846 bool hasNonInstance = false;
847 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
848 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
849 NamedDecl *D = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl();
850 if (IsInstanceMember(D)) {
851 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
852
853 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
854 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
855 // that's a special case.
856 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
857 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
858 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
859 }
860 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
861 }
862 else
863 hasNonInstance = true;
864 }
865
866 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
867 // member reference.
868 if (Classes.empty())
869 return IMA_Static;
870
871 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
872 // an implicit member reference.
873 if (isStaticContext)
874 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
875
876 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
877 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
878 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
879 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
880 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)->getParent(),
881 Classes))
882 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
883
884 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
885}
886
887/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
888static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
889 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
890 const LookupResult &R) {
891 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
892 SourceRange Range(Loc);
893 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
894
895 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
896 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
897 if (MD->isStatic()) {
898 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
899 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
900 << Range << R.getLookupName();
901 return;
902 }
903 }
904
905 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
906 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
907 return;
908 }
909
910 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000911}
912
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000913/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
914///
915/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000916bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000917 LookupResult &R) {
918 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
919
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000920 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000921 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000922 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
923 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000924 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000925 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000926 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
927 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000928
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000929 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
930 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
931 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
932 // dependent name.
933 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty()? CurContext : 0;
934 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000935 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
936 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
937
938 if (!R.empty()) {
939 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
940 R.suppressDiagnostics();
941
942 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
943 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
944 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
945 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
946
947 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
948 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
949 // Actually quite difficult!
950 if (isInstance)
951 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +0000952 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000953 else
954 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
955
956 // Do we really want to note all of these?
957 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
958 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
959
960 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
961 return false;
962 }
963 }
964 }
965
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000966 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000967 if (S && CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS)) {
968 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
969 if (SS.isEmpty())
970 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +0000971 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
972 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000973 else
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000974 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
975 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
976 << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +0000977 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
978 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +0000979 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
980 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
981 << ND->getDeclName();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000982
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000983 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
984 return false;
985 }
986
987 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
988 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
989 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
990 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
991 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
992 // to recover well anyway.
993 if (SS.isEmpty())
994 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000995 else
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000996 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
997 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
998 << SS.getRange();
999
1000 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
1001 return true;
1002 }
1003
1004 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001005 }
1006
1007 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
1008 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
1009 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
1010 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1011 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
1012 << SS.getRange();
1013 return true;
1014 }
1015
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001016 // Give up, we can't recover.
1017 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1018 return true;
1019}
1020
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001021Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
1022 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1023 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1024 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1025 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
1026 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1027 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1028
1029 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregored8f2882009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001030 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001031
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001032 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001033
1034 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
1035 DeclarationName Name;
1036 SourceLocation NameLoc;
1037 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001038 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
1039 Name, NameLoc, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001040
Douglas Gregor4ea80432008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001041 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001042
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001043 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1044 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregorea0a0a92010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001045 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1046 // (note: handled after lookup)
1047 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1048 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1049 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001050 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1051 // names a dependent type.
1052 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1053 // we need to handle these differently.
Douglas Gregorea0a0a92010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001054 if ((Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1055 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) ||
1056 (SS.isSet() && IsDependentIdExpression(*this, SS))) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001057 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, Name, NameLoc,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00001058 isAddressOfOperand,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001059 TemplateArgs);
1060 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001061
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001062 // Perform the required lookup.
1063 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1064 if (TemplateArgs) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001065 // Just re-use the lookup done by isTemplateName.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001066 DecomposeTemplateName(R, Id);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001067 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001068 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
1069 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001070
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001071 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1072 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001073 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
1074 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001075 if (E.isInvalid())
1076 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001077
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001078 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1079 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Steve Naroffebf4cb42008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001080 }
Chris Lattner59a25942008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001081 }
Douglas Gregorf15f5d32009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001082
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001083 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1084 return ExprError();
1085
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001086 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1087 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001088 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001089
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001090 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Bill Wendling4073ed52007-02-13 01:51:42 +00001091 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001092 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1093 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1094 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1095 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1096 }
1097
1098 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1099 // call, diagnose the problem.
1100 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001101 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R))
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001102 return ExprError();
1103
1104 assert(!R.empty() &&
1105 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001106
1107 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1108 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001109 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001110 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1111 R.clear();
1112 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
1113 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1114 return move(E);
1115 }
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00001116 }
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001117 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001118
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001119 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1120 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1121
1122 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001123 // Warn about constructs like:
1124 // if (void *X = foo()) { ... } else { X }.
1125 // In the else block, the pointer is always false.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001126
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001127 if (Var->isDeclaredInCondition() && Var->getType()->isScalarType()) {
1128 Scope *CheckS = S;
Douglas Gregor13a2c032009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001129 while (CheckS && CheckS->getControlParent()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001130 if (CheckS->isWithinElse() &&
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001131 CheckS->getControlParent()->isDeclScope(DeclPtrTy::make(Var))) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001132 ExprError(Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_value_always_zero)
Douglas Gregor13a2c032009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001133 << Var->getDeclName()
1134 << (Var->getType()->isPointerType()? 2 :
1135 Var->getType()->isBooleanType()? 1 : 0));
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001136 break;
1137 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001138
Douglas Gregor13a2c032009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001139 // Move to the parent of this scope.
1140 CheckS = CheckS->getParent();
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001141 }
1142 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001143 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001144 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1145 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1146 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1147 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1148 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1149 // type.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001150 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001151 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001152
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001153 QualType T = Func->getType();
1154 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001155 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001156 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001157 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001158 }
1159 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001160
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001161 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
1162 // C++ [expr.prim.general]p6:
1163 // Within the definition of a non-static member function, an
1164 // identifier that names a non-static member is transformed to a
1165 // class member access expression.
1166 // But note that &SomeClass::foo is grammatically distinct, even
1167 // though we don't parse it that way.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001168 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001169 bool isAbstractMemberPointer = (isAddressOfOperand && !SS.isEmpty());
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001170 if (!isAbstractMemberPointer)
1171 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001172 }
1173
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001174 if (TemplateArgs)
1175 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001176
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001177 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1178}
1179
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001180/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
1181Sema::OwningExprResult
1182Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1183 LookupResult &R,
1184 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1185 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1186 case IMA_Instance:
1187 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1188
1189 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1190 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1191 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1192 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1193
1194 case IMA_Mixed:
1195 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1196 case IMA_Unresolved:
1197 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1198
1199 case IMA_Static:
1200 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1201 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1202 if (TemplateArgs)
1203 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1204 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1205
1206 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1207 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1208 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1209 return ExprError();
1210 }
1211
1212 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1213 return ExprError();
1214}
1215
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001216/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1217/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1218/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1219/// this path.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001220Sema::OwningExprResult
1221Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1222 DeclarationName Name,
1223 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1224 DeclContext *DC;
1225 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) ||
1226 DC->isDependentContext() ||
1227 RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS))
1228 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, Name, NameLoc, 0);
1229
1230 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1231 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1232
1233 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1234 return ExprError();
1235
1236 if (R.empty()) {
1237 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_no_member) << Name << DC << SS.getRange();
1238 return ExprError();
1239 }
1240
1241 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1242}
1243
1244/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1245/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1246/// additional lookup.
1247///
1248/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1249/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1250///
1251/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
1252Sema::OwningExprResult
1253Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001254 IdentifierInfo *II,
1255 bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001256 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
1257
1258 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1259 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1260 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1261 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1262 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1263
1264 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1265 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1266 // ivar, that's an error.
1267 bool IsClassMethod = getCurMethodDecl()->isClassMethod();
1268
1269 bool LookForIvars;
1270 if (Lookup.empty())
1271 LookForIvars = true;
1272 else if (IsClassMethod)
1273 LookForIvars = false;
1274 else
1275 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1276 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian45878032010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001277 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001278 if (LookForIvars) {
Fariborz Jahanian45878032010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001279 IFace = getCurMethodDecl()->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001280 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1281 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1282 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1283 if (IsClassMethod)
1284 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1285 << IV->getDeclName());
1286
1287 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1288 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1289 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1290 return ExprError();
1291
1292 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1293 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1294 return ExprError();
1295
1296 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1297 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1298 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1299 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1300
1301 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1302 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1303 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1304 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001305 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001306 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
1307 OwningExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
1308 SelfName, false, false);
1309 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1310 return Owned(new (Context)
1311 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1312 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1313 }
1314 } else if (getCurMethodDecl()->isInstanceMethod()) {
1315 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
1316 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = getCurMethodDecl()->getClassInterface();
1317 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1318 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1319 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1320 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1321 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1322 }
1323 }
1324
1325 // Needed to implement property "super.method" notation.
1326 if (Lookup.empty() && II->isStr("super")) {
1327 QualType T;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001328
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001329 if (getCurMethodDecl()->isInstanceMethod())
1330 T = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(Context.getObjCInterfaceType(
1331 getCurMethodDecl()->getClassInterface()));
1332 else
1333 T = Context.getObjCClassType();
1334 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCSuperExpr(Loc, T));
1335 }
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001336 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1337 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1338 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1339 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1340 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1341 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1342 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1343 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1344 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1345 }
1346 }
1347 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001348 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1349 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001350}
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001351
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001352/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1353///
1354/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1355///
1356/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1357/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1358/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1359/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1360///
1361/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1362/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1363/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1364/// the class declaring the member.
1365///
1366/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1367/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1368/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001369bool
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001370Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1371 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001372 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001373 NamedDecl *Member) {
1374 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1375 if (!RD)
1376 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001377
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001378 QualType DestRecordType;
1379 QualType DestType;
1380 QualType FromRecordType;
1381 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1382 bool PointerConversions = false;
1383 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1384 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001385
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001386 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1387 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1388 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1389 PointerConversions = true;
1390 } else {
1391 DestType = DestRecordType;
1392 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001393 }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001394 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1395 if (Method->isStatic())
1396 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001397
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001398 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1399 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001400
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001401 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1402 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1403 PointerConversions = true;
1404 } else {
1405 FromRecordType = FromType;
1406 DestType = DestRecordType;
1407 }
1408 } else {
1409 // No conversion necessary.
1410 return false;
1411 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001412
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001413 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1414 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001415
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001416 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1417 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1418 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001419
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001420 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1421 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1422
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001423 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001424 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001425 // class name.
1426 //
1427 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1428 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1429 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1430 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1431 //
1432 // class Base { public: int x; };
1433 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1434 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1435 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1436 //
1437 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1438 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1439 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1440 // }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001441 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001442 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1443 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1444 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1445
1446 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1447
1448 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1449 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1450 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1451 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
1452 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
1453 FromLoc, FromRange))
1454 return true;
1455
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001456 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001457 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001458 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001459 /*isLvalue*/ !PointerConversions);
1460
1461 FromType = QType;
1462 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1463
1464 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1465 // we're done.
1466 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1467 return false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001468 }
1469 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001470
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001471 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001472
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001473 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1474 // down to the using declaration's type.
1475 //
1476 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1477 // class ever has member declarations.
1478 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1479 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1480 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1481 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1482
1483 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1484 // conversion is non-trivial.
1485 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1486 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
1487 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
1488 FromLoc, FromRange))
1489 return true;
1490
1491 QualType UType = URecordType;
1492 if (PointerConversions)
1493 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001494 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001495 /*isLvalue*/ !PointerConversions);
1496 FromType = UType;
1497 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1498 }
1499
1500 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1501 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1502 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001503 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001504
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001505 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType,
1506 DestRecordType,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001507 FromLoc,
1508 FromRange,
1509 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001510 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001511
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001512 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
1513 /*isLvalue=*/ !PointerConversions);
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001514 return false;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001515}
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001516
Douglas Gregorf405d7e2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001517/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001518static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedman2cfcef62009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001519 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001520 NamedDecl *FoundDecl, SourceLocation Loc,
1521 QualType Ty,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001522 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1523 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1524 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001525 if (SS.isSet()) {
1526 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1527 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001528 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001529
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001530 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001531 Member, FoundDecl, Loc, TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001532}
1533
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001534/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1535/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1536/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1537/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001538Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001539Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1540 LookupResult &R,
1541 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1542 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001543 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1544
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001545 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001546
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001547 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1548 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregor6493d9c2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001549 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001550 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001551 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001552 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001553 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001554
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001555 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1556 // 'this' expression now.
1557 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)->getThisType(Context);
1558 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1559 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001560 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1561 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1562 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1563 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001564 }
1565
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001566 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, This), ThisType,
1567 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1568 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001569 SS,
1570 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1571 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001572}
1573
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001574bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001575 const LookupResult &R,
1576 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001577 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1578 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1579 return false;
1580
1581 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001582 if (SS.isSet())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001583 return false;
1584
1585 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001586 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001587 return false;
1588
1589 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1590 // normal lookup:
1591 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1592 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1593
1594 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1595 // -- a declaration of a class member
1596 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1597 // original decl.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001598 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001599 return false;
1600
1601 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1602 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1603 // using-declaration
1604 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1605 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1606 // turn off ADL anyway).
1607 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1608 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1609 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1610 return false;
1611
1612 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1613 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1614 // template
1615 // And also for builtin functions.
1616 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1617 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1618
1619 // But also builtin functions.
1620 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1621 return false;
1622 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1623 return false;
1624 }
1625
1626 return true;
1627}
1628
1629
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001630/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1631/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1632/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1633/// will in fact be used.
1634static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1635 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1636 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1637 return true;
1638 }
1639
1640 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1641 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1642 return true;
1643 }
1644
1645 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1646 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1647 return true;
1648 }
1649
1650 return false;
1651}
1652
1653Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001654Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001655 LookupResult &R,
1656 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCall3a60c872009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001657 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1658 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor4b4844f2010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001659 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001660 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001661
1662 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1663 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1664 // functions and function templates.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001665 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1666 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001667 return ExprError();
1668
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001669 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1670 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1671 // we've picked a target.
1672 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1673
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001674 bool Dependent
1675 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001676 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001677 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001678 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
1679 SS.getRange(),
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001680 R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
1681 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult());
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001682 ULE->addDecls(R.begin(), R.end());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001683
1684 return Owned(ULE);
1685}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001686
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001687
1688/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
1689Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001690Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001691 SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1692 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall283b9012009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001693 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1694 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001695
1696 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1697 return ExprError();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00001698
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001699 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1700 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1701 // a template argument list.
1702 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1703 << Template << SS.getRange();
1704 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1705 return ExprError();
1706 }
1707
1708 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1709 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1710 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001711 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001712 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCallb48971d2009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001713 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001714 return ExprError();
1715 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001716
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001717 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1718 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1719 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1720 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001721 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001722 return ExprError();
1723
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001724 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1725 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001726 return ExprError();
1727
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001728 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1729 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1730 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1731 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001732 //
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001733 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1734 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1735 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001736 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001737 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump7dafa0d2010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001738 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1739 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1740 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1741 return ExprError();
1742 }
1743
Fariborz Jahanianfa24e102010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001744 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump8971a862010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001745 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1746 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1747 return ExprError();
1748 }
1749
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001750 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001751 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001752 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001753 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001754 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001755 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1756 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001757 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001758
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001759 ExprTy.addConst();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001760 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, false,
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001761 constAdded));
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001762 }
1763 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1764 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001765
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001766 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(), Loc, &SS);
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001767}
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001768
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001769Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
1770 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001771 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001772
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001773 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001774 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001775 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1776 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1777 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001778 }
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001779
Chris Lattnera81a0272008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001780 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1781 // string.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001782
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001783 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
1784 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001785 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001786 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001787 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001788
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001789 QualType ResTy;
1790 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1791 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1792 } else {
Anders Carlsson5bd8d192010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001793 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001794
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001795 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001796 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001797 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1798 }
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001799 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001800}
1801
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001802Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001803 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001804 bool Invalid = false;
1805 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1806 if (Invalid)
1807 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001808
Benjamin Kramer0a1abd42010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001809 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1810 PP);
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001811 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001812 return ExprError();
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001813
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001814 QualType Ty;
1815 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1816 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1817 else if (Literal.isWide())
1818 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedmaneb1df702010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001819 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1820 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001821 else
1822 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001823
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001824 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1825 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001826 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001827}
1828
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001829Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
1830 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001831 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
1832 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner9240b3e2009-01-26 22:36:52 +00001833 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattnerc4c18192009-01-16 07:10:29 +00001834 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001835 return Owned(new (Context) IntegerLiteral(llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff5faaef72009-01-20 19:53:53 +00001836 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001837 }
Ted Kremeneke9814182009-01-13 23:19:12 +00001838
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001839 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattnera1cf5f92008-09-30 20:53:45 +00001840 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
1841 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Steve Naroff8160ea22007-03-06 01:09:46 +00001842 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001843
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001844 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001845 bool Invalid = false;
1846 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
1847 if (Invalid)
1848 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001849
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001850 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Steve Naroff451d8f162007-03-12 23:22:38 +00001851 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001852 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001853 return ExprError();
1854
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001855 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001856
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001857 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001858 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001859 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001860 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001861 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001862 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001863 else
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001864 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001865
1866 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
1867
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001868 using llvm::APFloat;
1869 APFloat Val(Format);
1870
1871 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall122c8312009-12-24 11:09:08 +00001872
1873 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
1874 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
1875 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
1876 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001877 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001878 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001879 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001880 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001881 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
1882 } else {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001883 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001884 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
1885 }
1886
1887 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
1888 << Ty
1889 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
1890 }
1891
1892 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Chris Lattnere4edb8e2009-06-29 17:34:55 +00001893 Res = new (Context) FloatingLiteral(Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001894
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001895 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001896 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001897 } else {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001898 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001899
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001900 // long long is a C99 feature.
1901 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth4a1ee052007-08-29 22:13:52 +00001902 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001903 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
1904
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001905 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001906 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001907
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001908 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
1909 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
1910 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001911 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
1912 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001913 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00001914 } else {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001915 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
1916 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001917
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001918 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
1919 // be an unsigned int.
1920 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
1921
1922 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001923 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner7b939cf2007-08-23 21:58:08 +00001924 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
1925 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001926 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001927
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001928 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
1929 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
1930 // Does it fit in a signed int?
1931 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001932 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001933 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001934 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001935 Width = IntSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001936 }
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001937 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001938
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001939 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001940 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001941 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001942
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001943 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
1944 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
1945 // Does it fit in a signed long?
1946 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001947 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001948 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001949 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001950 Width = LongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001951 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001952 }
1953
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001954 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001955 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001956 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001957
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001958 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
1959 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
1960 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
1961 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001962 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001963 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001964 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001965 Width = LongLongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001966 }
1967 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001968
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001969 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
1970 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001971 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001972 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001973 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001974 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001975 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001976
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001977 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
1978 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00001979 }
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001980 Res = new (Context) IntegerLiteral(ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00001981 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001982
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001983 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
1984 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001985 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001986 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001987
1988 return Owned(Res);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001989}
1990
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001991Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
1992 SourceLocation R, ExprArg Val) {
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00001993 Expr *E = Val.takeAs<Expr>();
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001994 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001995 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001996}
1997
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00001998/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00001999/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002000bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002001 SourceLocation OpLoc,
2002 const SourceRange &ExprRange,
2003 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002004 if (exprType->isDependentType())
2005 return false;
2006
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002007 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2008 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2009 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2010 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2011 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2012 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2013
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002014 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002015 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002016 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002017 if (isSizeof)
2018 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2019 return false;
2020 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002021
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002022 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002023 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002024 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2025 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002026 return false;
2027 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002028
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002029 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002030 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2031 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002032 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002033
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002034 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
Fariborz Jahanian1dcb3222009-04-24 17:34:33 +00002035 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCInterfaceType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002036 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattnercd2a8c52009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002037 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2038 return true;
Chris Lattner37920f52009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002039 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002040
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002041 return false;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002042}
2043
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002044bool Sema::CheckAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2045 const SourceRange &ExprRange) {
2046 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002047
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002048 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002049 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2050 return false;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002051
2052 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2053 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2054 return false;
2055
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002056 if (E->getBitField()) {
2057 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
2058 return true;
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002059 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002060
2061 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2062 // bit-field.
2063 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002064 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002065 return false;
2066
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002067 return CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
2068}
2069
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002070/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002071Action::OwningExprResult
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002072Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002073 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002074 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002075 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002076 return ExprError();
2077
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002078 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002079
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002080 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2081 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2082 return ExprError();
2083
2084 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002085 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002086 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2087 R.getEnd()));
2088}
2089
2090/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2091/// operand.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002092Action::OwningExprResult
2093Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002094 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2095 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2096 bool isInvalid = false;
2097 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2098 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2099 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
2100 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002101 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002102 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2103 isInvalid = true;
2104 } else {
2105 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2106 }
2107
2108 if (isInvalid)
2109 return ExprError();
2110
2111 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2112 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2113 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2114 R.getEnd()));
2115}
2116
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002117/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2118/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2119/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002120Action::OwningExprResult
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002121Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2122 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Chris Lattner0d8b1a12006-11-20 04:34:45 +00002123 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002124 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002125
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002126 if (isType) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002127 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
2128 (void) GetTypeFromParser(TyOrEx, &TInfo);
2129 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002130 }
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002131
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002132 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
2133 Action::OwningExprResult Result
2134 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2135
2136 if (Result.isInvalid())
2137 DeleteExpr(ArgEx);
2138
2139 return move(Result);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002140}
2141
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002142QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002143 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2144 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002145
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002146 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002147 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002148 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002149
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002150 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2151 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2152 return V->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002153
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002154 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002155 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2156 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002157 return QualType();
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002158}
2159
2160
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002161
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002162Action::OwningExprResult
2163Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2164 tok::TokenKind Kind, ExprArg Input) {
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002165 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
2166 switch (Kind) {
2167 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
2168 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostInc; break;
2169 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostDec; break;
2170 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002171
Eli Friedmancfdd40c2009-11-18 03:38:04 +00002172 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, move(Input));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002173}
2174
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002175Action::OwningExprResult
2176Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2177 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002178 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
2179 Base = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Base));
2180
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002181 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get()),
2182 *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002183
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002184 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor7a77a6b2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002185 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
2186 Base.release();
2187 Idx.release();
2188 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2189 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2190 }
2191
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002192 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002193 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman254a1a22008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002194 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2195 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2196 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002197 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, move(Base),move(Idx));
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002198 }
2199
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002200 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(move(Base), LLoc, move(Idx), RLoc);
2201}
2202
2203
2204Action::OwningExprResult
2205Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2206 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2207 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get());
2208 Expr *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
2209
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002210 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002211 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2212 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2213 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002214
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002215 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002216
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002217 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002218 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002219 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002220 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002221 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2222 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002223 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2224 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2225 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2226 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002227 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002228 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2229 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002230 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002231 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattneraee0cfd2007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002232 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002233 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2234 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002235 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002236 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002237 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002238 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2239 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2240 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002241 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002242 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002243 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2244 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2245 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2246 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002247 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattner41977962007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002248 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002249 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begemanc1bf0612009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002250
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002251 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2252 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002253 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2254 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002255 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002256 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2257 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2258 // force the promotion here.
2259 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2260 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002261 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
2262 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002263 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2264
2265 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2266 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002267 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002268 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2269 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2270 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2271 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002272 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
2273 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002274 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2275
2276 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2277 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002278 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroffb3096442007-06-09 03:47:53 +00002279 } else {
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002280 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2281 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002282 }
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002283 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002284 if (!(IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() &&
2285 IndexExpr->getType()->isScalarType()) && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002286 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2287 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffb29cdd52007-07-10 18:23:31 +00002288
Daniel Dunbar4782a6e2009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002289 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinigb7608d72009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002290 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2291 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig914244e2009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002292 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2293
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002294 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002295 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2296 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002297 // incomplete types are not object types.
2298 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2299 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2300 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2301 return ExprError();
2302 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002303
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002304 if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002305 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002306 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2307 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002308 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002309
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002310 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
2311 if (ResultType->isObjCInterfaceType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
2312 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2313 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2314 return ExprError();
2315 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002316
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002317 Base.release();
2318 Idx.release();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002319 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002320 ResultType, RLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002321}
2322
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002323QualType Sema::
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002324CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002325 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002326 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbarc0429402009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002327 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2328 // see FIXME there.
2329 //
2330 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2331 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002332 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002333
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002334 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002335 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002336
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002337 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002338 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2339 // to be selected.
2340 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002341
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002342 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2343 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman0359e122009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002344 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002345
2346 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2347 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002348 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002349 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2350 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002351 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002352 do
2353 compStr++;
2354 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002355 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002356 do
2357 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002358 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002359 }
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002360
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002361 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002362 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2363 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002364 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
2365 << std::string(compStr,compStr+1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002366 return QualType();
2367 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002368
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002369 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2370 // operates on.
2371 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002372 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002373
2374 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002375 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002376
2377 while (*compStr) {
2378 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2379 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2380 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2381 return QualType();
2382 }
2383 }
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002384 }
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002385
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002386 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002387 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002388 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002389 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002390 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begemanac8183a2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002391 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002392 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002393 if (HexSwizzle)
2394 CompSize--;
2395
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002396 if (CompSize == 1)
2397 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002398
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002399 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002400 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002401 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2402 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2403 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2404 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffddf5a1d2007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002405 }
2406 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002407}
2408
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002409static Decl *FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002410 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002411 const Selector &Sel,
2412 ASTContext &Context) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002413
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002414 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002415 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002416 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002417 return OMD;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002418
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002419 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2420 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002421 if (Decl *D = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002422 Context))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002423 return D;
2424 }
2425 return 0;
2426}
2427
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002428static Decl *FindGetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002429 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002430 const Selector &Sel,
2431 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002432 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2433 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002434 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002435 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002436 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002437 GDecl = PD;
2438 break;
2439 }
2440 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002441 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002442 GDecl = OMD;
2443 break;
2444 }
2445 }
2446 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002447 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002448 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2449 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002450 GDecl = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel, Context);
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002451 if (GDecl)
2452 return GDecl;
2453 }
2454 }
2455 return GDecl;
2456}
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002457
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002458Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002459Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseType,
2460 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002461 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2462 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
2463 DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
2464 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2465 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
2466
2467 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2468 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2469 //
2470 // T* t;
2471 // t.f;
2472 //
2473 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2474 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2475 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2476 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002477 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002478 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2479 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002480 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002481 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002482 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002483 return ExprError();
2484 }
2485 }
2486
Douglas Gregorea0a0a92010-01-11 18:40:55 +00002487 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002488
2489 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2490 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002491 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002492 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2493 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep()),
2494 SS.getRange(),
2495 FirstQualifierInScope,
2496 Name, NameLoc,
2497 TemplateArgs));
2498}
2499
2500/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2501/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2502/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2503static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2504 Expr *BaseExpr,
2505 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002506 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002507 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002508 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2509 // diagnostics.
2510 if (!BaseExpr)
2511 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002512
2513 // FIXME: this is an exceedingly lame diagnostic for some of the more
2514 // complicated cases here.
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002515 DeclContext *DC = R.getRepresentativeDecl()->getDeclContext();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002516 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_not_direct_base_or_virtual)
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002517 << SS.getRange() << DC << BaseType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002518}
2519
2520// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2521// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2522// type. The restriction here is:
2523//
2524// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2525// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2526// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2527//
2528// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2529// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2530// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2531// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2532bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2533 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002534 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002535 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002536 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2537 if (!BaseRT) {
2538 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2539 // dependent.
2540 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2541 return false;
2542 }
2543 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002544
2545 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002546 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2547 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
2548 if (!BaseExpr && !IsInstanceMember((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()))
2549 return false;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002550
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002551 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
2552 CXXRecordDecl *RecordD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>((*I)->getDeclContext());
2553 while (RecordD->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
2554 RecordD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordD->getParent());
2555
2556 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
2557 MemberRecord.insert(RecordD->getCanonicalDecl());
2558
2559 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2560 return false;
2561 }
2562
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002563 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002564 return true;
2565}
2566
2567static bool
2568LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2569 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
2570 SourceLocation OpLoc, const CXXScopeSpec &SS) {
2571 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2572 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002573 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002574 << BaseRange))
2575 return true;
2576
2577 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2578 if (SS.isSet()) {
2579 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2580 // nested-name-specifier.
2581 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2582
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002583 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS)) {
2584 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2585 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2586 return true;
2587 }
2588
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002589 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002590
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002591 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2592 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2593 << DC << SS.getRange();
2594 return true;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002595 }
2596 }
2597
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002598 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2599 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002600
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002601 if (!R.empty())
2602 return false;
2603
2604 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2605 // for typos.
2606 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002607 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC) &&
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002608 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2609 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2610 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002611 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2612 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002613 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2614 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2615 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002616 return false;
2617 } else {
2618 R.clear();
2619 }
2620
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002621 return false;
2622}
2623
2624Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002625Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg BaseArg, QualType BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002626 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2627 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2628 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
2629 DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
2630 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2631 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
2632
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002633 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2634 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002635 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002636 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2637 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2638 Name, NameLoc,
2639 TemplateArgs);
2640
2641 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupMemberName);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002642
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002643 // Implicit member accesses.
2644 if (!Base) {
2645 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2646 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2647 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2648 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
2649 OpLoc, SS))
2650 return ExprError();
2651
2652 // Explicit member accesses.
2653 } else {
2654 OwningExprResult Result =
2655 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002656 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ DeclPtrTy());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002657
2658 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2659 Owned(Base);
2660 return ExprError();
2661 }
2662
2663 if (Result.get())
2664 return move(Result);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002665 }
2666
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002667 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002668 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2669 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002670}
2671
2672Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002673Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseExprType,
2674 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2675 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002676 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002677 LookupResult &R,
2678 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2679 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002680 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002681 if (IsArrow) {
2682 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2683 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2684 }
2685
2686 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier =
2687 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep());
2688 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2689 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
2690
2691 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002692 return ExprError();
2693
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002694 if (R.empty()) {
2695 // Rederive where we looked up.
2696 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2697 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2698 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002699
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002700 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002701 << MemberName << DC
2702 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002703 return ExprError();
2704 }
2705
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002706 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2707 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2708 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2709 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2710 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2711 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2712 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2713 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2714 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2715 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
2716 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002717 return ExprError();
2718
2719 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2720 // result.
2721 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002722 bool Dependent =
John McCall71739032009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002723 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002724 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002725 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002726
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002727 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2728 // pick a member.
2729 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2730
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002731 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2732 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2733 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002734 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2735 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002736 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
2737 MemberName, MemberLoc,
2738 TemplateArgs);
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002739 MemExpr->addDecls(R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002740
2741 return Owned(MemExpr);
2742 }
2743
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002744 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002745 NamedDecl *FoundDecl = *R.begin();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002746 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2747
2748 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2749
2750 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2751 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2752 // error cases.
2753 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2754 return ExprError();
2755
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002756 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2757 if (!BaseExpr) {
2758 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
2759 if (!IsInstanceMember(MemberDecl))
2760 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getNameLoc(), MemberDecl);
2761
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002762 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2763 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2764 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2765 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002766 }
2767
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002768 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2769 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2770 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2771 // explicitly qualified.
2772 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2773 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2774 }
2775
2776 // Check the use of this member.
2777 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2778 Owned(BaseExpr);
2779 return ExprError();
2780 }
2781
2782 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2783 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2784 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman78cde142009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002785 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2786 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002787 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2788 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2789
2790 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2791 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2792 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2793 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2794 else {
2795 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2796 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2797 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2798
2799 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2800 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2801
2802 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2803 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2804 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2805 }
2806
2807 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002808 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002809 return ExprError();
2810 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002811 FD, FoundDecl, MemberLoc, MemberType));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002812 }
2813
2814 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2815 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
2816 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002817 Var, FoundDecl, MemberLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002818 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
2819 }
2820
2821 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2822 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2823 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002824 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002825 MemberFn->getType()));
2826 }
2827
2828 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2829 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2830 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002831 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberLoc, Enum->getType()));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002832 }
2833
2834 Owned(BaseExpr);
2835
2836 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
2837 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc,diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
2838 << MemberName << int(IsArrow));
2839
2840 // We found a declaration kind that we didn't expect. This is a
2841 // generic error message that tells the user that she can't refer
2842 // to this member with '.' or '->'.
2843 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc,
2844 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
2845 << MemberName << int(IsArrow));
2846}
2847
2848/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
2849/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
2850/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
2851/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
2852/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
2853/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
2854/// an ordinary member expression.
2855///
2856/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
2857/// fixed for ObjC++.
2858Sema::OwningExprResult
2859Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00002860 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002861 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002862 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00002863 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002864
Steve Naroffeaaae462007-12-16 21:42:28 +00002865 // Perform default conversions.
2866 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002867
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002868 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002869 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
2870
2871 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2872 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002873
2874 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002875 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002876 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
2877 // call, and continue on.
2878 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2879 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
2880 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
2881 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
2882 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002883 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
2884 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002885 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
2886 ->isRecordType()))) {
2887 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
2888 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
2889 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002890 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002891
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002892 OwningExprResult NewBase
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002893 = ActOnCallExpr(0, ExprArg(*this, BaseExpr), Loc,
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002894 MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), 0, Loc);
2895 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002896 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002897
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002898 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
2899 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
2900 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
2901 }
2902 }
2903 }
2904
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002905 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
2906 // use that.
2907 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002908 if (IsArrow) {
2909 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
2910 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
2911 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
2912 if (OPT->getPointeeType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ObjCId) &&
2913 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00002914 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
2915 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002916 }
2917 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002918 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
2919 // is a reference to 'isa'.
2920 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
2921 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002922 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002923 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002924 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002925
Fariborz Jahanian04b258c2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00002926 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
2927 // use that.
2928 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
2929 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
2930 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
2931 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
2932 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
2933 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
2934 }
2935 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002936
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002937 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002938
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002939 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002940 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002941 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
2942 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
2943 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
2944 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
2945 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
2946 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
2947 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
2948 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
2949 // Check the use of this method.
2950 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
2951 return ExprError();
2952 }
2953 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
2954 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
2955 Selector SetterSel =
2956 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
2957 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
2958 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
2959 if (!Setter) {
2960 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
2961 // methods.
Steve Naroffbb69c942009-10-01 23:46:04 +00002962 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002963 }
2964 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
2965 if (!Setter)
2966 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002967
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002968 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
2969 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002970
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002971 if (Getter || Setter) {
2972 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002973
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002974 if (Getter)
2975 PType = Getter->getResultType();
2976 else
2977 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
2978 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
2979 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002980 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002981 PType,
2982 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
2983 }
2984 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
2985 << MemberName << BaseType);
2986 }
2987 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002988
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002989 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
2990 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
2991 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002992 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002993 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002994
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002995 if (IsArrow) {
2996 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002997 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002998 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
2999 ;
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003000 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3001 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3002 // struct MyRecord foo;
3003 // foo->bar
3004 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3005 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3006 // by now.
3007 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3008 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003009 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003010 IsArrow = false;
3011 } else {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003012 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3013 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3014 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson524d5a42009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003015 }
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003016 } else {
3017 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3018 // type *foo;
3019 // foo.bar
3020 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3021 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3022 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3023 // the appropriate pointer type
3024 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3025 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3026 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3027 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3028 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003029 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003030 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3031 IsArrow = true;
3032 }
3033 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003034 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003035
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003036 // Handle field access to simple records. This also handles access
3037 // to fields of the ObjC 'id' struct.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003038 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003039 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
3040 RTy, OpLoc, SS))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003041 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003042 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003043 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003044
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003045 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3046 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003047 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
3048 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCInterfaceType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003049 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003050 const ObjCInterfaceType *IFaceT =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003051 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceType() : BaseType->getAs<ObjCInterfaceType>();
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003052 if (IFaceT) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003053 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3054
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003055 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = IFaceT->getDecl();
3056 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003057 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003058
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003059 if (!IV) {
3060 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3061 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3062 LookupMemberName);
3063 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl) &&
3064 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003065 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003066 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3067 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003068 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3069 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003070 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003071 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003072 }
3073 }
3074
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003075 if (IV) {
3076 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3077 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3078 // error cases.
3079 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3080 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003081
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003082 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3083 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3084 return ExprError();
3085 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3086 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3087 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3088 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3089 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3090 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3091 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3092 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3093 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3094 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3095 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3096 // AST for a function decl.
3097 Decl *ImplDecl = ObjCImpDecl.getAs<Decl>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003098 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003099 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ImplDecl))
3100 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3101 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
3102 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ImplDecl))
3103 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3104 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003105
3106 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3107 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003108 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003109 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003110 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003111 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3112 // @protected
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003113 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003114 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffd1b64be2009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003115 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003116
3117 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3118 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003119 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahaniana458c4f2009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003120 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003121 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003122 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003123 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianb1378f92008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003124 }
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003125 }
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003126 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003127 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3128 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003129 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003130 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003131
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003132 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003133 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003134 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel, Context)) {
3135 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3136 // Check the use of this declaration
3137 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3138 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003139
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003140 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
3141 MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3142 }
3143 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3144 // Check the use of this method.
3145 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3146 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003147
Ted Kremenek2c809302010-02-11 22:41:21 +00003148 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCMessageExpr(Context, BaseExpr, Sel,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003149 OMD->getResultType(),
3150 OMD, OpLoc, MemberLoc,
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003151 NULL, 0));
3152 }
3153 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003154
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003155 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003156 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003157 }
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003158 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3159 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003160 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003161 if (!IsArrow && (OPT = BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003162 const ObjCInterfaceType *IFaceT = OPT->getInterfaceType();
3163 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = IFaceT->getDecl();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003164 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003165
Daniel Dunbaref89086c2008-09-03 01:05:41 +00003166 // Search for a declared property first.
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003167 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = IFace->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003168 // Check whether we can reference this property.
3169 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3170 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanianb2ab73d2009-05-08 19:36:34 +00003171 QualType ResTy = PD->getType();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003172 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003173 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter = IFace->lookupInstanceMethod(Sel);
Fariborz Jahanianfe9e3942009-05-08 20:20:55 +00003174 if (DiagnosePropertyAccessorMismatch(PD, Getter, MemberLoc))
3175 ResTy = Getter->getResultType();
Fariborz Jahanianb2ab73d2009-05-08 19:36:34 +00003176 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, ResTy,
Chris Lattner43df5562009-02-16 18:35:08 +00003177 MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3178 }
Daniel Dunbaref89086c2008-09-03 01:05:41 +00003179 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00003180 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = OPT->qual_begin(),
3181 E = OPT->qual_end(); I != E; ++I)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003182 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003183 // Check whether we can reference this property.
3184 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3185 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner43df5562009-02-16 18:35:08 +00003186
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003187 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
Chris Lattner43df5562009-02-16 18:35:08 +00003188 MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3189 }
Daniel Dunbaref89086c2008-09-03 01:05:41 +00003190 // If that failed, look for an "implicit" property by seeing if the nullary
3191 // selector is implemented.
3192
3193 // FIXME: The logic for looking up nullary and unary selectors should be
3194 // shared with the code in ActOnInstanceMessage.
3195
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003196 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003197 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter = IFace->lookupInstanceMethod(Sel);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003198
Daniel Dunbaref89086c2008-09-03 01:05:41 +00003199 // If this reference is in an @implementation, check for 'private' methods.
3200 if (!Getter)
Steve Naroffbb69c942009-10-01 23:46:04 +00003201 Getter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(Sel);
Daniel Dunbaref89086c2008-09-03 01:05:41 +00003202
Steve Naroff1df62692008-10-22 19:16:27 +00003203 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis1559d67b2009-07-21 00:06:20 +00003204 if (!Getter)
3205 Getter = IFace->getCategoryInstanceMethod(Sel);
Daniel Dunbaref89086c2008-09-03 01:05:41 +00003206 if (Getter) {
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003207 // Check if we can reference this property.
3208 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
3209 return ExprError();
Steve Naroff1d984fe2009-03-11 13:48:17 +00003210 }
3211 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
3212 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003213 Selector SetterSel =
3214 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003215 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003216 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Steve Naroff1d984fe2009-03-11 13:48:17 +00003217 if (!Setter) {
3218 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
3219 // methods.
Steve Naroffbb69c942009-10-01 23:46:04 +00003220 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Steve Naroff1d984fe2009-03-11 13:48:17 +00003221 }
3222 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis1559d67b2009-07-21 00:06:20 +00003223 if (!Setter)
3224 Setter = IFace->getCategoryInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003225
Steve Naroff1d984fe2009-03-11 13:48:17 +00003226 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
3227 return ExprError();
3228
Fariborz Jahanianc1d2fa52010-01-19 17:48:02 +00003229 if (Getter) {
Steve Naroff1d984fe2009-03-11 13:48:17 +00003230 QualType PType;
Fariborz Jahanianc1d2fa52010-01-19 17:48:02 +00003231 PType = Getter->getResultType();
Fariborz Jahanian9a846652009-08-20 17:02:02 +00003232 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter, PType,
Steve Naroff1d984fe2009-03-11 13:48:17 +00003233 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3234 }
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003235
3236 // Attempt to correct for typos in property names.
3237 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3238 LookupOrdinaryName);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003239 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IFace, false, OPT) &&
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003240 Res.getAsSingle<ObjCPropertyDecl>()) {
3241 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_property_not_found_suggest)
3242 << MemberName << BaseType << Res.getLookupName()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003243 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3244 Res.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003245 ObjCPropertyDecl *Property = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCPropertyDecl>();
3246 Diag(Property->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003247 << Property->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003248
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003249 return LookupMemberExpr(Res, BaseExpr, IsArrow, OpLoc, SS,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003250 ObjCImpDecl);
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003251 }
Fariborz Jahanianc5d61df2010-02-19 18:30:30 +00003252 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
3253 << MemberName << BaseType;
3254 if (Setter && !Getter)
3255 Diag(Setter->getLocation(), diag::note_getter_unavailable)
3256 << MemberName << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3257 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanian21f54ee2007-11-12 22:29:28 +00003258 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003259
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003260 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003261 if (!IsArrow &&
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003262 BaseType->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ObjCId) &&
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003263 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003264 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003265 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003266
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003267 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner6c7ce102009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003268 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003269 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003270 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3271 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003272 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003273 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003274 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003275 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003276
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003277 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3278 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3279
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003280 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003281}
3282
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003283/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3284/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3285/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3286/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3287/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3288///
3289/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3290/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3291/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3292/// only be called
3293/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3294/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3295/// aren't properly put in the context chain
3296Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg BaseArg,
3297 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3298 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
3299 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
3300 UnqualifiedId &Id,
3301 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl,
3302 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3303 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3304 return ExprError();
3305
3306 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3307
3308 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
3309 DeclarationName Name;
3310 SourceLocation NameLoc;
3311 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3312 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
3313 Name, NameLoc, TemplateArgs);
3314
3315 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3316
3317 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3318 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3319 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3320
3321 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
3322 BaseArg = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(BaseArg));
3323
3324 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
3325 OwningExprResult Result(*this);
Douglas Gregorea0a0a92010-01-11 18:40:55 +00003326 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003327 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003328 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3329 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3330 Name, NameLoc,
3331 TemplateArgs);
3332 } else {
3333 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupMemberName);
3334 if (TemplateArgs) {
3335 // Re-use the lookup done for the template name.
3336 DecomposeTemplateName(R, Id);
3337 } else {
3338 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003339 SS, ObjCImpDecl);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003340
3341 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3342 Owned(Base);
3343 return ExprError();
3344 }
3345
3346 if (Result.get()) {
3347 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3348 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3349 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3350 // call now.
3351 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3352 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
Douglas Gregor0d5b0a12010-02-24 21:29:12 +00003353 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameLoc, move(Result));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003354
3355 return move(Result);
3356 }
3357 }
3358
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003359 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003360 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3361 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003362 }
3363
3364 return move(Result);
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003365}
3366
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003367Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3368 FunctionDecl *FD,
3369 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3370 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
3371 Diag (CallLoc,
3372 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3373 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003374 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003375 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
3376 } else {
3377 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3378 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
3379
3380 // Instantiate the expression.
Douglas Gregor8c702532010-02-05 07:33:43 +00003381 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3382 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson657bad42009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003383
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003384 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param,
3385 ArgList.getInnermost().getFlatArgumentList(),
Douglas Gregor01afeef2009-08-28 20:31:08 +00003386 ArgList.getInnermost().flat_size());
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003387
John McCall76d824f2009-08-25 22:02:44 +00003388 OwningExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003389 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003390 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003391
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003392 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3393 InitializedEntity Entity
3394 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param);
3395 InitializationKind Kind
3396 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3397 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3398 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
3399
3400 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003401 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003402 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&ResultE, 1));
3403 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003404 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003405
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003406 // Build the default argument expression.
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003407 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003408 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003409 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003410
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003411 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3412 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3413 // be properly destroyed.
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003414 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3415 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Anders Carlsson714d0962009-12-15 19:16:31 +00003416 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i)
3417 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003418 }
3419
3420 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003421 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003422}
3423
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003424/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3425/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3426/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3427/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3428/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3429/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003430bool
3431Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003432 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003433 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003434 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3435 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003436 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003437 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3438 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003439 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003440
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003441 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3442 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3443 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3444 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3445 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
3446 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType() << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003447 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003448 }
3449
3450 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3451 // them.
3452 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3453 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3454 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3455 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
3456 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType() << Fn->getSourceRange()
3457 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3458 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3459 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003460 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003461 return true;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003462 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003463 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003464 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003465 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003466 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3467 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3468 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3469 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3470 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003471 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian4fa66ce2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003472 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003473 if (Invalid)
3474 return true;
3475 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3476 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3477 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003478
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003479 return false;
3480}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003481
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003482bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3483 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3484 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3485 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3486 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3487 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003488 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003489 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3490 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3491 bool Invalid = false;
3492 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3493 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3494 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3495 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003496 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003497 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003498 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003499
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003500 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003501 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3502 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003503
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003504 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3505 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003506 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003507 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003508 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003509
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003510 // Pass the argument
3511 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3512 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3513 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregor96596c92009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003514
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003515
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003516 InitializedEntity Entity =
3517 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param)
3518 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(ProtoArgType);
3519 OwningExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
3520 SourceLocation(),
3521 Owned(Arg));
3522 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3523 return true;
3524
3525 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003526 } else {
Anders Carlssonc80a1272009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003527 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003528
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003529 OwningExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003530 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003531 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3532 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003533
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003534 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003535 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003536 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003537 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003538
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003539 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003540 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003541 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003542 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i < NumArgs; i++) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003543 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +00003544 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003545 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003546 }
3547 }
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003548 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003549}
3550
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003551/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003552/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3553/// locations.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003554Action::OwningExprResult
3555Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3556 MultiExprArg args,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003557 SourceLocation *CommaLocs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003558 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003559
3560 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
3561 fn = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(fn));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003562
Anders Carlsson3cbc8592009-05-01 19:30:39 +00003563 Expr *Fn = fn.takeAs<Expr>();
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003564 Expr **Args = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(args.release());
Chris Lattner38dbdb22007-07-21 03:03:59 +00003565 assert(Fn && "no function call expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003566
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003567 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003568 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3569 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3570 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3571 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3572 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003573 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003574 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3575 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003576
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003577 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3578 Args[I]->Destroy(Context);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003579
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003580 NumArgs = 0;
3581 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003582
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003583 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3584 RParenLoc));
3585 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003586
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003587 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003588 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003589 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3590 // Fn.
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003591 bool Dependent = false;
3592 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3593 Dependent = true;
3594 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3595 Dependent = true;
3596
3597 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003598 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003599 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3600
3601 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3602 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3603 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3604 CommaLocs, RParenLoc));
3605
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003606 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3607
3608 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3609 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3610 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3611 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3612 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3613 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3614 // method template.
3615 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
3616 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*MemE->decls_begin()));
Douglas Gregor8f184a32009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003617 (void)MemE;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003618
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003619 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3620 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003621 }
3622
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003623 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003624 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003625 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003626 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003627 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3628 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003629 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003630
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003631 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003632 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003633 if (BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemD ||
3634 BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003635 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT =
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003636 dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(BO->getType())) {
3637 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getResultType().getNonReferenceType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003638
3639 ExprOwningPtr<CXXMemberCallExpr>
3640 TheCall(this, new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003641 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3642 RParenLoc));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003643
3644 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3645 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003646 TheCall.get(), 0))
3647 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson63dce022009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003648
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003649 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003650 RParenLoc))
3651 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003652
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003653 return Owned(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.release()).release());
3654 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003655 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003656 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3657 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003658 }
3659 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003660 }
3661
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003662 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003663 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003664 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003665
Eli Friedmane14b1992009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003666 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003667 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3668 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
3669 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3670 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003671 }
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003672
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003673 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
3674 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3675 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3676
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003677 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3678}
3679
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003680/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3681/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003682/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3683/// block-pointer type.
3684///
3685/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
3686Sema::OwningExprResult
3687Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3688 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3689 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3690 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3691 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3692
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003693 // Promote the function operand.
3694 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3695
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003696 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3697 // of arguments and function on error.
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003698 ExprOwningPtr<CallExpr> TheCall(this, new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3699 Args, NumArgs,
3700 Context.BoolTy,
3701 RParenLoc));
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003702
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003703 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3704 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3705 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3706 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003707 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003708 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003709 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3710 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003711 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003712 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003713 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003714 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003715 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003716 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003717 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3718 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3719
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003720 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003721 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003722 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall.get(),
3723 FDecl))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003724 return ExprError();
3725
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003726 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +00003727 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getResultType().getNonReferenceType());
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003728
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003729 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003730 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003731 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003732 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003733 } else {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003734 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003735
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003736 if (FDecl) {
3737 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3738 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3739 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisddcd1322009-06-30 02:35:26 +00003740 if (FDecl->getBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003741 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003742 Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003743 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size())) {
3744 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3745 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
3746 }
3747 }
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003748 }
3749
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003750 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003751 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3752 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
3753 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003754 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3755 Arg->getType(),
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003756 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3757 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003758 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003759 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003760 }
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00003761 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003762
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003763 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3764 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003765 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3766 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003767
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003768 // Check for sentinels
3769 if (NDecl)
3770 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003771
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003772 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003773 if (FDecl) {
3774 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall.get()))
3775 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003776
Douglas Gregor15fc9562009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003777 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003778 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall.take());
3779 } else if (NDecl) {
3780 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall.get()))
3781 return ExprError();
3782 }
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003783
Anders Carlssonf8984012009-08-16 03:06:32 +00003784 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.take());
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003785}
3786
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003787Action::OwningExprResult
3788Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
3789 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003790 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroff57eb2c52007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003791 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003792 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003793
3794 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3795 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3796 if (!TInfo)
3797 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3798
3799 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(InitExpr));
3800}
3801
3802Action::OwningExprResult
3803Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
3804 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
3805 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003806 Expr *literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(InitExpr.get());
Anders Carlsson2c1ec6d2007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003807
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003808 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003809 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003810 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3811 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor1c37d9e2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003812 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3813 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003814 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003815 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003816 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003817 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003818
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003819 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregor1b303932009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003820 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003821 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003822 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003823 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003824 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
3825 OwningExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
3826 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&literalExpr, 1),
3827 &literalType);
3828 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003829 return ExprError();
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003830 InitExpr.release();
3831 literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Result.get());
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003832
Chris Lattner79413952008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003833 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003834 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003835 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003836 return ExprError();
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003837 }
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003838
3839 Result.release();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003840
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003841 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003842 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003843}
3844
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003845Action::OwningExprResult
3846Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003847 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3848 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
3849 Expr **InitList = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(initlist.release());
Anders Carlsson4692db02007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003850
Steve Naroff30d242c2007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003851 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003852 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003853
Ted Kremenek013041e2010-02-19 01:50:18 +00003854 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(LBraceLoc, InitList, NumInit,
3855 RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003856 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003857 return Owned(E);
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003858}
3859
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003860static CastExpr::CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
3861 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003862 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003863 return CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
3864
3865 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
3866 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003867 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
3868 CastExpr::CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
Fariborz Jahanian2b9fc832009-12-15 21:34:52 +00003869 CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003870 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3871 return CastExpr::CK_PointerToIntegral;
3872 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003873
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003874 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
3875 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3876 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast;
3877 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
3878 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer;
3879 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3880 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToFloating;
3881 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003882
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003883 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
3884 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3885 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast;
3886 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3887 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingToIntegral;
3888 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003889
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003890 // FIXME: Assert here.
3891 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
3892 return CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
3893}
3894
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003895/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redl955a0672009-07-29 13:50:23 +00003896bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003897 CastExpr::CastKind& Kind,
Fariborz Jahanian1cec0c42009-08-26 18:55:36 +00003898 CXXMethodDecl *& ConversionDecl,
3899 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003900 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Fariborz Jahanian1cec0c42009-08-26 18:55:36 +00003901 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind, FunctionalStyle,
3902 ConversionDecl);
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003903
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00003904 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003905
3906 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
3907 // type needs to be scalar.
3908 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
3909 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003910 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToVoid;
3911 return false;
3912 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003913
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003914 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003915 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003916 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
3917 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00003918 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003919 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
3920 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonec143772009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003921 Kind = CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003922 return false;
3923 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003924
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003925 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003926 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003927 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003928 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003929 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003930 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003931 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003932 castExpr->getType())) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003933 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
3934 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3935 break;
3936 }
3937 }
3938 if (Field == FieldEnd)
3939 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
3940 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonec143772009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003941 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003942 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003943 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003944
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003945 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
3946 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
3947 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3948 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003949
3950 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003951 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003952 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3953 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003954 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003955 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003956
3957 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003958 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003959
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003960 if (castType->isVectorType())
3961 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
3962 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
3963 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
3964
3965 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && isa<ObjCSuperExpr>(castExpr))
Steve Naroffb47acdb2009-04-08 23:52:26 +00003966 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_illegal_super_cast) << TyR;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003967
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003968 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
3969 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003970
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003971 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003972 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
3973 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType() && castExprType->isArithmeticType())
3974 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3975 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
3976 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3977 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
3978 if (!castType->isIntegralType() && castType->isArithmeticType())
3979 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3980 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
3981 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003982 }
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003983
3984 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003985 return false;
3986}
3987
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003988bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
3989 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003990 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003991
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003992 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00003993 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003994 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003995 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003996 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003997 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003998 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003999 } else
4000 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004001 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004002 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004003
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004004 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004005 return false;
4006}
4007
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004008bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004009 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004010 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004011
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004012 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004013
Nate Begemanc8961a42009-06-27 22:05:55 +00004014 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
4015 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004016 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
4017 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
4018 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
4019 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004020 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004021 return false;
4022 }
4023
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004024 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004025 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
4026 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004027 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
4028 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
4029 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
4030 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004031
4032 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
4033 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
4034 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004035
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004036 Kind = CastExpr::CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004037 return false;
4038}
4039
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004040Action::OwningExprResult
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004041Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004042 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
4043 assert((Ty != 0) && (Op.get() != 0) &&
4044 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff1a2cf6b2007-07-16 23:25:18 +00004045
John McCall97513962010-01-15 18:39:57 +00004046 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
4047 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
4048 if (!castTInfo)
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004049 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004050
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004051 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004052 Expr *castExpr = (Expr *)Op.get();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004053 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004054 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, move(Op),
4055 castTInfo);
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004056
4057 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
4058}
4059
4060Action::OwningExprResult
4061Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
4062 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
4063 Expr *castExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Op.get());
4064
Anders Carlssone9766d52009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004065 CXXMethodDecl *Method = 0;
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004066 CastExpr::CastKind Kind = CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
4067 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlssone9766d52009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004068 Kind, Method))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004069 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssone9766d52009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004070
4071 if (Method) {
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004072 // FIXME: preserve type source info here
4073 OwningExprResult CastArg = BuildCXXCastArgument(LParenLoc, Ty->getType(),
4074 Kind, Method, move(Op));
Daniel Dunbar4782a6e2009-09-17 06:31:17 +00004075
Anders Carlssone9766d52009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004076 if (CastArg.isInvalid())
4077 return ExprError();
Daniel Dunbar4782a6e2009-09-17 06:31:17 +00004078
Anders Carlssone9766d52009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004079 castExpr = CastArg.takeAs<Expr>();
4080 } else {
4081 Op.release();
Fariborz Jahanian3df87672009-08-29 19:15:16 +00004082 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004083
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004084 return Owned(new (Context) CStyleCastExpr(Ty->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
4085 Kind, castExpr, Ty,
Anders Carlssonf10e4142009-08-07 22:21:05 +00004086 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004087}
4088
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004089/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4090/// of comma binary operators.
4091Action::OwningExprResult
4092Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg EA) {
4093 Expr *expr = EA.takeAs<Expr>();
4094 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4095 if (!E)
4096 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004097
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004098 OwningExprResult Result(*this, E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004099
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004100 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
4101 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, move(Result),
4102 Owned(E->getExpr(i)));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004103
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004104 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), move(Result));
4105}
4106
4107Action::OwningExprResult
4108Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
4109 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004110 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004111 ParenListExpr *PE = (ParenListExpr *)Op.get();
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004112 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004113
4114 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004115 // then handle it as such.
4116 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4117 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4118 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4119 return ExprError();
4120 }
4121
4122 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4123 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4124 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4125
4126 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4127 // braces instead of the original commas.
4128 Op.release();
Ted Kremenek013041e2010-02-19 01:50:18 +00004129 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(LParenLoc, &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004130 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4131 E->setType(Ty);
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004132 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Owned(E));
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004133 } else {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004134 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004135 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
4136 Op = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Op));
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004137 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004138 }
4139}
4140
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004141Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004142 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004143 MultiExprArg Val,
4144 TypeTy *TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004145 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4146 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004147 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4148 Expr *expr;
4149 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4150 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4151 else
4152 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004153 return Owned(expr);
4154}
4155
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004156/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4157/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattner2c486602009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004158/// C99 6.5.15
4159QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4160 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004161 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4162 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
4163 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
4164
John McCall71d8d9b2010-03-11 19:43:18 +00004165 CheckSignCompare(LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
John McCall1fa36b72009-11-05 09:23:39 +00004166
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004167 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
4168 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
4169 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4170 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4171 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4172 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004173
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004174 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004175 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
4176 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4177 << CondTy;
4178 return QualType();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004179 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004180
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004181 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004182 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4183 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004184
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004185 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4186 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004187 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4188 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4189 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004190 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004191
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004192 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4193 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004194 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4195 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004196 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004197 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004198 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004199 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004200 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004201 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004202
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004203 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004204 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004205 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4206 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4207 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4208 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4209 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4210 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4211 << LHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004212 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
4213 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman3e1852f2008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004214 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004215 }
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004216 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4217 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004218 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004219 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004220 // promote the null to a pointer.
4221 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004222 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004223 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004224 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004225 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004226 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004227 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004228 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004229
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004230 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4231 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4232 QuestionLoc);
4233 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4234 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004235
4236
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004237 // Handle block pointer types.
4238 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4239 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4240 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4241 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004242 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4243 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004244 return destType;
4245 }
4246 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004247 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004248 return QualType();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004249 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004250 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4251 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4252 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004253 return LHSTy;
4254 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004255 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004256 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4257 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004258
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004259 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4260 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004261 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004262 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004263 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4264 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4265 // to get a consistent AST.
4266 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004267 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4268 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004269 return incompatTy;
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004270 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004271 // The block pointer types are compatible.
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004272 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4273 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroffea4c7802009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004274 return LHSTy;
4275 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004276
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004277 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4278 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4279 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004280 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4281 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004282
4283 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4284 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4285 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004286 QualType destPointee
4287 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004288 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004289 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4290 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4291 // Promote to void*.
4292 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004293 return destType;
4294 }
4295 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004296 QualType destPointee
4297 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004298 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004299 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
Eli Friedmanb0bc5592009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004300 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004301 // Promote to void*.
Eli Friedmanb0bc5592009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004302 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004303 return destType;
4304 }
4305
4306 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4307 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4308 return LHSTy;
4309 }
4310 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4311 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4312 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4313 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4314 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4315 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4316 // to get a consistent AST.
4317 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004318 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4319 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004320 return incompatTy;
4321 }
4322 // The pointer types are compatible.
4323 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4324 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4325 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4326 // type.
4327 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4328 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004329 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4330 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004331 return LHSTy;
4332 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004333
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004334 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4335 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4336 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4337 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004338 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004339 return RHSTy;
4340 }
4341 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4342 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4343 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004344 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004345 return LHSTy;
4346 }
Daniel Dunbar484603b2008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004347
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004348 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004349 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4350 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004351 return QualType();
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004352}
4353
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004354/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4355/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4356QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4357 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4358 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4359 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004360
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004361 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4362 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4363 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4364 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4365 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4366 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4367 return LHSTy;
4368 }
4369 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4370 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4371 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4372 return RHSTy;
4373 }
4374 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4375 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4376 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4377 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4378 return LHSTy;
4379 }
4380 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4381 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4382 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4383 return RHSTy;
4384 }
4385 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4386 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4387 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4388 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4389 return LHSTy;
4390 }
4391 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4392 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4393 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4394 return RHSTy;
4395 }
4396 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4397 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004398
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004399 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4400 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4401 return LHSTy;
4402 }
4403 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4404 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4405 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004406
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004407 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4408 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4409 // type. This allows
4410 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4411 // where B is a subclass of A.
4412 //
4413 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4414 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4415 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4416 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004417
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004418 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4419 // It could return the composite type.
4420 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4421 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4422 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4423 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4424 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4425 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4426 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4427 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4428 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4429 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4430 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4431 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4432 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4433 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004434 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004435 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4436 ;
4437 else {
4438 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4439 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4440 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4441 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
4442 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4443 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4444 return incompatTy;
4445 }
4446 // The object pointer types are compatible.
4447 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4448 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4449 return compositeType;
4450 }
4451 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4452 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4453 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4454 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4455 QualType destPointee
4456 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4457 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4458 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4459 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4460 // Promote to void*.
4461 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4462 return destType;
4463 }
4464 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4465 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4466 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4467 QualType destPointee
4468 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4469 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4470 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4471 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4472 // Promote to void*.
4473 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4474 return destType;
4475 }
4476 return QualType();
4477}
4478
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004479/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004480/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004481Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
4482 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
4483 ExprArg Cond, ExprArg LHS,
4484 ExprArg RHS) {
4485 Expr *CondExpr = (Expr *) Cond.get();
4486 Expr *LHSExpr = (Expr *) LHS.get(), *RHSExpr = (Expr *) RHS.get();
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004487
4488 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4489 // was the condition.
4490 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
4491 if (isLHSNull)
4492 LHSExpr = CondExpr;
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004493
4494 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr,
Chris Lattnerdaaa9f22007-07-16 21:39:03 +00004495 RHSExpr, QuestionLoc);
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004496 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004497 return ExprError();
4498
4499 Cond.release();
4500 LHS.release();
4501 RHS.release();
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004502 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00004503 isLHSNull ? 0 : LHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004504 ColonLoc, RHSExpr, result));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004505}
4506
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004507// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004508// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004509// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4510// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4511// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004512Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004513Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004514 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004515
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004516 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4517 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4518 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4519 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4520 return Compatible;
4521 }
4522
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004523 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004524 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4525 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004526
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004527 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004528 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4529 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004530
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004531 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004532
4533 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4534 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4535 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianece85822009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004536 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004537 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004538 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004539
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004540 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4541 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004542 // version of void...
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004543 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004544 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004545 return ConvTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004546
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004547 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004548 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4549 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004550 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004551
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004552 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004553 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004554 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004555
4556 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004557 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4558 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004559 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004560 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004561 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004562 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4563 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4564 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4565 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4566 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4567 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004568 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004569 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004570 else if (lhptee->isSignedIntegerType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004571 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004572
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004573 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004574 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004575 else if (rhptee->isSignedIntegerType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004576 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004577
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004578 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4579 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4580 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4581 // warning can be disabled.
4582 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4583 return ConvTy;
4584 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4585 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004586
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004587 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4588 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4589 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4590 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4591 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4592 do {
4593 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4594 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004595
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004596 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4597 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4598 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004599
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004600 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004601 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004602 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004603
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004604 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004605 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004606 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004607 return ConvTy;
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004608}
4609
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004610/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4611/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4612/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4613// types.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004614Sema::AssignConvertType
4615Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004616 QualType rhsType) {
4617 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004618
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004619 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004620 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4621 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004622
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004623 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4624 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4625 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004626
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004627 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004628
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004629 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004630 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004631 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004632
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004633 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4634 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4635 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4636 }
4637 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004638 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004639 return ConvTy;
4640}
4641
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004642/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4643/// for assignment compatibility.
4644Sema::AssignConvertType
4645Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004646 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4647 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004648 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4649 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004650 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004651 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004652 }
4653 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4654 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004655 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4656 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004657 return IncompatiblePointer;
4658 return Compatible;
4659 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004660 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004661 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004662 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004663 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4664 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4665 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4666 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4667 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4668 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004669
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004670 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4671 return Compatible;
4672 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4673 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004674 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004675}
4676
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004677/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4678/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004679/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4680///
4681/// int a, *pint;
4682/// short *pshort;
4683/// struct foo *pfoo;
4684///
4685/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4686/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4687/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4688/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4689///
4690/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004691/// C99 spec dictates.
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004692///
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004693Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004694Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004695 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4696 // them.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004697 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4698 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004699
4700 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerf5c973d2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004701 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff44fd8ff2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004702
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004703 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4704 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4705 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4706 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4707 return Compatible;
4708 }
4709
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004710 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4711 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4712 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4713 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4714 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4715 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4716 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004717 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004718 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson24ebce62007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004719 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004720 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahaniana1e34202007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004721 }
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004722 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4723 // to the same ExtVector type.
4724 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4725 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4726 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
4727 if (!rhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType())
4728 return Compatible;
4729 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004730
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004731 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004732 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004733 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004734 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004735 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4736 lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004737 if (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType))
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004738 return IncompatibleVectors;
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004739 }
4740 return Incompatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004741 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004742
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004743 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType())
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004744 return Compatible;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004745
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004746 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004747 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004748 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004749
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004750 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004751 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004752
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004753 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004754 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004755 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4756 return Compatible;
4757 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004758 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004759 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4760 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004761 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004762
4763 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004764 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004765 return Compatible;
4766 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004767 return Incompatible;
4768 }
4769
4770 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4771 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedman8163b7a2009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004772 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004773
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004774 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004775 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004776 return Compatible;
4777
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004778 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4779 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004780
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004781 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004782 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004783 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004784 }
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004785 return Incompatible;
4786 }
4787
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004788 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4789 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4790 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004791
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004792 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004793 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004794 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4795 return Compatible;
4796 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004797 }
4798 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004799 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004800 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004801 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004802 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
4803 return Compatible;
4804 }
4805 // Treat block pointers as objects.
4806 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4807 return Compatible;
4808 return Incompatible;
4809 }
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004810 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004811 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004812 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4813 return Compatible;
4814
4815 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004816 return PointerToInt;
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004817
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004818 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004819 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004820
4821 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004822 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004823 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004824 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004825 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004826 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
4827 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
4828 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4829 return Compatible;
4830
4831 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
4832 return PointerToInt;
4833
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004834 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004835 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004836 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4837 return Compatible;
4838 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004839 }
4840 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004841 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004842 return Compatible;
4843 return Incompatible;
4844 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004845
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004846 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004847 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004848 return Compatible;
Bill Wendling216423b2007-05-30 06:30:29 +00004849 }
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004850 return Incompatible;
Steve Naroff9eb24652007-05-02 21:58:15 +00004851}
4852
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004853/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
4854/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004855static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004856 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
4857 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
4858 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenek013041e2010-02-19 01:50:18 +00004859 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(SourceLocation(),
4860 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004861 SourceLocation());
4862 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
4863 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
4864
4865 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
4866 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004867 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00004868 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004869 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004870}
4871
4872Sema::AssignConvertType
4873Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
4874 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
4875
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004876 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004877 // transparent_union GCC extension.
4878 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00004879 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004880 return Incompatible;
4881
4882 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
4883 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
4884 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
4885 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004886 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
4887 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004888 it != itend; ++it) {
4889 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
4890 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
4891 // 1) void pointer
4892 // 2) null pointer constant
4893 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004894 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004895 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004896 InitField = *it;
4897 break;
4898 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004899
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004900 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004901 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004902 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004903 InitField = *it;
4904 break;
4905 }
4906 }
4907
4908 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
4909 == Compatible) {
4910 InitField = *it;
4911 break;
4912 }
4913 }
4914
4915 if (!InitField)
4916 return Incompatible;
4917
4918 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
4919 return Compatible;
4920}
4921
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004922Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004923Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004924 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4925 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
4926 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
4927 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
4928 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00004929 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00004930 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004931 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner0d5640c2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00004932 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004933 }
4934
4935 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
4936 // structures.
4937 }
4938
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004939 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
4940 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004941 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
4942 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004943 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004944 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004945 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004946 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004947 return Compatible;
4948 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004949
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004950 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004951 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregora121b752009-11-03 16:56:39 +00004952 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004953 // expressions that surpress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004954 //
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004955 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004956 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00004957 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004958
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004959 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
4960 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004961
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004962 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
4963 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004964 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
4965 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
4966 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
4967 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004968 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004969 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonReferenceType(),
4970 CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004971 return result;
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004972}
4973
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00004974QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004975 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00004976 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004977 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00004978 return QualType();
Steve Naroff6f49f5d2007-05-29 14:23:36 +00004979}
4980
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004981QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004982 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00004983 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004984 QualType lhsType =
4985 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
4986 QualType rhsType =
4987 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004988
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004989 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00004990 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00004991 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00004992
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004993 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
4994 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004995 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
4996 // FIXME: Should we warn here?
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004997 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
4998 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>())
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004999 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005000 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005001 return lhsType->isExtVectorType() ? lhsType : rhsType;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005002 }
5003 }
5004 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005005
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005006 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
5007 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
5008 bool swapped = false;
5009 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5010 swapped = true;
5011 std::swap(rex, lex);
5012 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
5013 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005014
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005015 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005016 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005017 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
5018 if (EltTy->isIntegralType() && rhsType->isIntegralType()) {
5019 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005020 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005021 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5022 return lhsType;
5023 }
5024 }
5025 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
5026 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
5027 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005028 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005029 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5030 return lhsType;
5031 }
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005032 }
5033 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005034
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005035 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005036 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005037 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005038 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00005039 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00005040}
5041
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005042QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
5043 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar060d5e22009-01-05 22:42:10 +00005044 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005045 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005046
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005047 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005048
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005049 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
5050 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5051 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005052
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005053 // Check for division by zero.
5054 if (isDiv &&
5055 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005056 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005057 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005058
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005059 return compType;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005060}
5061
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005062QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005063 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005064 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5065 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5066 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5067 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5068 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005069
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005070 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005071
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005072 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5073 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005074
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005075 // Check for remainder by zero.
5076 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005077 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
5078 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005079
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005080 return compType;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005081}
5082
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005083QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005084 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005085 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5086 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5087 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5088 return compType;
5089 }
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005090
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005091 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005092
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005093 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005094 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5095 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5096 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005097 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005098 }
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005099
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005100 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5101 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005102 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005103 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5104
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005105 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005106
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005107 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005108 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005109
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005110 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5111 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005112 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5113 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005114 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005115 return QualType();
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005116 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005117
5118 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5119 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5120 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005121 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005122 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5123 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5124 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5125 return QualType();
5126 }
5127
5128 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5129 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5130 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005131 } else {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005132 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005133 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005134 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005135 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5136 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005137 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5138 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005139 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005140 return QualType();
5141 }
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005142 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
5143 if (PointeeTy->isObjCInterfaceType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
5144 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5145 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5146 return QualType();
5147 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005148
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005149 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005150 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5151 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5152 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5153 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5154 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005155 }
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005156 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5157 }
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005158 return PExp->getType();
5159 }
5160 }
5161
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005162 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005163}
5164
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005165// C99 6.5.6
5166QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005167 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5168 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5169 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5170 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5171 return compType;
5172 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005173
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005174 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005175
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005176 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005177
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005178 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005179 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5180 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005181 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005182 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005183 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005184
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005185 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005186 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff4eed7a12009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005187 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005188
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005189 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005190
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005191 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5192 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5193 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5194 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5195 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5196 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5197 return QualType();
5198 }
5199
5200 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5201 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5202 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5203 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5204 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005205 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005206 return QualType();
5207 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005208
5209 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5210 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5211 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005212 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005213 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005214 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005215 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005216 return QualType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005217
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005218 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
5219 if (lpointee->isObjCInterfaceType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
5220 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5221 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5222 return QualType();
5223 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005224
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005225 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005226 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5227 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5228 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5229 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5230 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5231 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005232 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005233 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5234
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005235 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005236 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005237 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005238
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005239 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005240 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman1974e532008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005241 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005242
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005243 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5244 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5245 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5246 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5247 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5248 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5249 return QualType();
5250 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005251
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005252 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5253 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5254 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5255 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005256 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005257 return QualType();
5258 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005259
5260 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5261 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5262 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5263 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5264 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005265 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5266 << rex->getSourceRange()
5267 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005268 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005269
Eli Friedman168fe152009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005270 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5271 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5272 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5273 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5274 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5275 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5276 return QualType();
5277 }
5278 } else {
5279 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5280 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5281 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5282 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5283 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5284 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5285 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5286 return QualType();
5287 }
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005288 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005289
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005290 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5291 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5292 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5293 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5294 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005295 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005296 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005297
5298 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005299 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5300 }
5301 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005302
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005303 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005304}
5305
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005306// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005307QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005308 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005309 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
5310 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005311 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005312
Nate Begemane46ee9a2009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005313 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5314 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5315 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5316
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005317 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5318 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005319 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5320 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5321 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5322 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5323 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005324 }
Chris Lattner3c133402007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005325 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005326 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005327
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005328 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005329
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005330 // Sanity-check shift operands
5331 llvm::APSInt Right;
5332 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar687fa862009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005333 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5334 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn2f085712009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005335 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005336 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5337 else {
5338 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5339 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5340 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5341 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5342 }
5343 }
5344
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005345 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005346 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005347}
5348
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005349// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005350QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005351 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
5352 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)OpaqueOpc;
5353
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005354 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005355 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005356 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005357
John McCall71d8d9b2010-03-11 19:43:18 +00005358 CheckSignCompare(lex, rex, Loc, &Opc);
John McCall644a4182009-11-05 00:40:04 +00005359
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005360 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
Steve Naroff47fea352007-08-10 18:26:40 +00005361 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5362 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5363 else {
5364 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5365 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5366 }
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005367 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5368 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005369
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005370 if (!lType->isFloatingType()
5371 && !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational)) {
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005372 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5373 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5374 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005375 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparisons of enum constants. These can arise
Ted Kremenekde9e9682009-03-20 19:57:37 +00005376 // from macro expansions, and are usually quite deliberate.
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005377 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5378 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
5379 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped))
5380 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped))
Ted Kremenek9ffbe412009-03-20 18:35:45 +00005381 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() &&
5382 !isa<EnumConstantDecl>(DRL->getDecl()))
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005383 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_selfcomparison));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005384
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005385 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5386 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5387 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5388 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005389
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005390 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5391 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005392 Expr *literalString = 0;
5393 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005394 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005395 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005396 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005397 literalString = lex;
5398 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005399 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5400 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005401 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005402 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005403 literalString = rex;
5404 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5405 }
5406
5407 if (literalString) {
5408 std::string resultComparison;
5409 switch (Opc) {
5410 case BinaryOperator::LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5411 case BinaryOperator::GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5412 case BinaryOperator::LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5413 case BinaryOperator::GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5414 case BinaryOperator::EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5415 case BinaryOperator::NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
5416 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5417 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005418
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005419 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5420 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5421 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
5422 << literalString->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00005423 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(Loc), ", ")
5424 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(lex->getLocStart(), "strcmp(")
5425 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(PP.getLocForEndOfToken(rex->getLocEnd()),
5426 resultComparison));
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005427 }
Ted Kremeneke451eae2007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005428 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005429
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005430 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005431 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005432
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005433 if (isRelational) {
5434 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005435 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005436 } else {
Ted Kremeneke2763b02007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005437 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005438 if (lType->isFloatingType() && rType->isFloatingType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005439 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005440
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005441 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005442 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005443 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005444
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005445 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005446 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005447 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005448 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005449
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005450 // All of the following pointer related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5451 // when handling null pointer constants. One day, we can consider making them
5452 // errors (when -pedantic-errors is enabled).
Steve Naroff808eb8f2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005453 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005454 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005455 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005456 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005457 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005458
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005459 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005460 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5461 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005462 if (!isRelational &&
5463 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5464 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5465 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
5466 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5467 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5468 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5469 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5470 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5471 return ResultTy;
5472 }
5473 }
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005474 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5475 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5476 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5477 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5478 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5479 //
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005480 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005481 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005482 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
5483 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(lex, rex,
5484 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005485 if (T.isNull()) {
5486 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5487 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5488 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005489 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005490 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005491 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005492 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005493 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005494 }
5495
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005496 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5497 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005498 return ResultTy;
5499 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005500 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5501 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5502 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5503 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5504 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5505 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5506 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5507 }
5508 } else if (!isRelational &&
5509 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5510 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5511 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5512 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5513 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5514 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5515 }
5516 } else {
5517 // Invalid
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005518 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005519 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff75c17232007-06-13 21:41:08 +00005520 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005521 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005522 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005523 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffcdee44c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005524 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005525
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005526 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005527 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005528 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005529 if (RHSIsNull &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005530 (lType->isPointerType() ||
5531 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Anders Carlsson83133d92009-08-24 18:03:14 +00005532 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005533 return ResultTy;
5534 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005535 if (LHSIsNull &&
5536 (rType->isPointerType() ||
5537 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Anders Carlsson83133d92009-08-24 18:03:14 +00005538 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005539 return ResultTy;
5540 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005541
5542 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005543 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005544 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5545 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005546 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5547 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5548 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5549 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5550 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5551 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5552 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5553 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005554 // types.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005555 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
5556 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(lex, rex,
5557 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005558 if (T.isNull()) {
5559 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005560 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005561 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005562 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005563 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005564 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005565 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005566 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005567 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005568
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005569 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5570 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005571 return ResultTy;
5572 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005573
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005574 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005575 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5576 return ResultTy;
5577 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005578
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005579 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005580 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005581 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5582 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005583
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005584 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedmana6638ca2009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005585 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005586 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005587 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005588 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005589 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005590 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005591 }
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005592 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005593 if (!isRelational
5594 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5595 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005596 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005597 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005598 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005599 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005600 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5601 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5602 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005603 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005604 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005605 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005606 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005607
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005608 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005609 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005610 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5611 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005612 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005613 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005614 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005615 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005616
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005617 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5618 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005619 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005620 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005621 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005622 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005623 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffea54d9e2008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005624 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005625 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005626 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005627 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5628 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005629 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005630 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffb788d9b2008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005631 }
Fariborz Jahanian134cbef2007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005632 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005633 if (lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005634 unsigned DiagID = 0;
5635 if (RHSIsNull) {
5636 if (isRelational)
5637 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
5638 } else if (isRelational)
5639 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5640 else
5641 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005642
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005643 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005644 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattnerd466ea12009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005645 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005646 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005647 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005648 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffcdee44c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005649 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005650 if (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType()) {
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005651 unsigned DiagID = 0;
5652 if (LHSIsNull) {
5653 if (isRelational)
5654 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
5655 } else if (isRelational)
5656 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5657 else
5658 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005659
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005660 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005661 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattnerd466ea12009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005662 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005663 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005664 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005665 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00005666 }
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005667 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005668 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5669 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005670 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005671 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005672 }
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005673 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5674 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005675 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005676 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005677 }
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005678 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005679}
5680
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005681/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005682/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005683/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5684/// types.
5685QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005686 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005687 bool isRelational) {
5688 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5689 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005690 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005691 if (vType.isNull())
5692 return vType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005693
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005694 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5695 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005696
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005697 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5698 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5699 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
5700 if (!lType->isFloatingType()) {
5701 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5702 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5703 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005704 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_selfcomparison));
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005705 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005706
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005707 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
5708 if (!isRelational && lType->isFloatingType()) {
5709 assert (rType->isFloatingType());
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005710 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005711 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005712
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005713 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
5714 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
5715 // elements for floating point vectors.
5716 if (lType->isIntegerType())
5717 return lType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005718
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005719 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005720 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005721 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005722 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattner5d688962009-03-31 07:46:52 +00005723 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005724 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5725
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005726 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005727 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005728 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5729}
5730
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005731inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005732 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Steve Naroff94a5aca2007-07-16 22:23:01 +00005733 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005734 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005735
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005736 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005737
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00005738 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005739 return compType;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005740 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005741}
5742
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005743inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005744 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc) {
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005745 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5746 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5747 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005748
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005749 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
5750 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005751
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005752 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson35a99d92009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005753 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005754
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005755 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
5756 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
5757 // The operands are both implicitly converted to type bool (clause 4).
5758 StandardConversionSequence LHS;
5759 if (!IsStandardConversion(lex, Context.BoolTy,
5760 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, LHS))
5761 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Anders Carlsson35a99d92009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005762
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005763 if (PerformImplicitConversion(lex, Context.BoolTy, LHS,
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005764 AA_Passing, /*IgnoreBaseAccess=*/false))
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005765 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005766
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005767 StandardConversionSequence RHS;
5768 if (!IsStandardConversion(rex, Context.BoolTy,
5769 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, RHS))
5770 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005771
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005772 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rex, Context.BoolTy, RHS,
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005773 AA_Passing, /*IgnoreBaseAccess=*/false))
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005774 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005775
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005776 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
5777 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
5778 // The result is a bool.
5779 return Context.BoolTy;
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00005780}
5781
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005782/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
5783/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
5784/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
5785///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005786static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005787 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
5788 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
5789 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
5790 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005791 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005792 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
5793 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
5794 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
5795 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005796 }
5797 }
5798 return false;
5799}
5800
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005801/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
5802/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
5803static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005804 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005805 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005806 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005807 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
5808 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005809 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
5810 return false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005811
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005812 unsigned Diag = 0;
5813 bool NeedType = false;
5814 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005815 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005816 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005817 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5818 NeedType = true;
5819 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005820 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005821 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5822 NeedType = true;
5823 break;
Chris Lattner9b3bbe92008-11-17 19:51:54 +00005824 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005825 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
5826 break;
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005827 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
5828 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005829 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005830 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
5831 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005832 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5833 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005834 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
5835 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregored0cfbd2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00005836 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00005837 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00005838 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005839 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005840 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
5841 break;
Steve Naroffba756cb2008-09-26 14:41:28 +00005842 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005843 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5844 break;
Fariborz Jahanian8a1810f2008-11-22 18:39:36 +00005845 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
5846 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
5847 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5118c412008-11-22 20:25:50 +00005848 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
5849 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
5850 break;
Fariborz Jahaniane8d28902009-12-15 23:59:41 +00005851 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
5852 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
5853 break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005854 }
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00005855
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005856 SourceRange Assign;
5857 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
5858 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005859 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005860 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005861 else
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005862 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005863 return true;
5864}
5865
5866
5867
5868// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005869QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
5870 SourceLocation Loc,
5871 QualType CompoundType) {
5872 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
5873 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005874 return QualType();
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005875
5876 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
5877 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005878
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005879 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005880 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005881 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005882 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005883 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
5884 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
5885 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005886 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005887 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005888 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005889 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005890
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005891 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
5892 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
5893 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005894 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005895 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
5896 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
5897 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
5898 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ||
5899 UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Minus) &&
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005900 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005901 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00005902 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
5903 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
5904 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattnered9f14c2009-03-09 07:11:10 +00005905 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
5906 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00005907 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
5908 << (UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ? "+" : "-")
5909 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00005910 }
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005911 }
5912 } else {
5913 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedmanb05c41e2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00005914 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005915 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005916
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005917 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005918 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005919 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005920
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00005921 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
5922 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005923 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00005924 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
5925 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00005926 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005927 // operand.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005928 return LHSType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00005929}
5930
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005931// C99 6.5.17
5932QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattnerf6e1e302008-07-25 20:54:07 +00005933 // Comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1), but not unary conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00005934 // C++ does not perform this conversion (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
5935 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
5936 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00005937
5938 // FIXME: Check that RHS type is complete in C mode (it's legal for it to be
5939 // incomplete in C++).
5940
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005941 return RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff95af0132007-03-30 23:47:58 +00005942}
5943
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005944/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
5945/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00005946QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
5947 bool isInc) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00005948 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
5949 return Context.DependentTy;
5950
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005951 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
5952 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Steve Naroffd50c88e2007-04-05 21:15:20 +00005953
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00005954 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
5955 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
5956 if (!isInc) {
5957 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
5958 return QualType();
5959 }
5960 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
5961 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
5962 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005963 // OK!
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005964 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
5965 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005966
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005967 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005968 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005969 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5970 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5971 << Op->getSourceRange();
5972 return QualType();
5973 }
5974
5975 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005976 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005977 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005978 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5979 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5980 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
5981 return QualType();
5982 }
5983
5984 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005985 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005986 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005987 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005988 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005989 << ResType))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005990 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00005991 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
5992 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCInterfaceType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
5993 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5994 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
5995 return QualType();
5996 }
Eli Friedman090addd2010-01-03 00:20:48 +00005997 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005998 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
5999 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006000 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006001 } else {
6002 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00006003 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006004 return QualType();
Steve Naroff46ba1eb2007-04-03 23:13:13 +00006005 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006006 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroff9e1e5512007-08-23 21:37:33 +00006007 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006008 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006009 return QualType();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006010 return ResType;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00006011}
6012
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006013/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006014/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006015/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
6016/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
6017/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
6018/// - &(x) => x
6019/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
6020/// - &s.xx => s
6021/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
6022/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
6023/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
6024/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006025static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006026 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006027 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006028 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006029 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006030 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
6031 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
6032 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006033 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006034 return 0;
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006035 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006036 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006037 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006038 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
6039 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006040 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
6041 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
6042 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
6043 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
6044 }
6045 return 0;
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006046 }
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006047 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
6048 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006049
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006050 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006051 case UnaryOperator::Real:
6052 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
6053 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
6054 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
6055 default:
6056 return 0;
6057 }
6058 }
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006059 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006060 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006061 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006062 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
6063 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006064 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006065 default:
6066 return 0;
6067 }
6068}
6069
6070/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006071/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006072/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006073/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00006074/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006075/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006076/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006077QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006078 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
6079 op = op->IgnoreParens();
6080
Douglas Gregor19b8c4f2008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006081 if (op->isTypeDependent())
6082 return Context.DependentTy;
6083
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006084 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6085 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6086 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
6087 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Deref)
6088 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6089 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6090 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6091 }
6092 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6093 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6094 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006095 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner67315442008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006096 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes17f345f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006097
Sebastian Redl9a8dd0d2010-01-11 15:56:56 +00006098 MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(op);
6099 if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction && ME &&
6100 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) {
6101 ValueDecl *dcl = cast<MemberExpr>(op)->getMemberDecl();
6102 // &f where f is a member of the current object, or &o.f, or &p->f
6103 // All these are not allowed, and we need to catch them before the dcl
6104 // branch of the if, below.
6105 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6106 << dcl;
6107 // FIXME: Improve this diagnostic and provide a fixit.
6108
6109 // Now recover by acting as if the function had been accessed qualified.
6110 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6111 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(dcl->getDeclContext()))
6112 .getTypePtr());
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006113 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
6114 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6115 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6116 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6117 if (isSFINAEContext())
6118 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl9a8dd0d2010-01-11 15:56:56 +00006119 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006120 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006121 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006122 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006123 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006124 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6125 << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006126 return QualType();
6127 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006128 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006129 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6130 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6131 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006132 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson8abde4b2010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006133 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006134 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006135 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemana6b47a42009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006136 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006137 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian385db802009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006138 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6139 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6140 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6141 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6142 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson3fa58d12009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006143 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6144 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson01ccf992009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006145 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6146 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006147 } else if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(op)) {
6148 return Context.OverloadTy;
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006149 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006150 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006151 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6152 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006153 if (vd->getStorageClass() == VarDecl::Register) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006154 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6155 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006156 return QualType();
6157 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006158 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006159 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006160 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor9aa8b552008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006161 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006162 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6163 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006164 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006165 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006166 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6167 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006168 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006169 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6170 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6171 return QualType();
6172 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006173
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006174 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6175 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006176 }
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006177 }
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006178 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(dcl)) {
Nuno Lopes5773a1b2008-12-16 22:58:26 +00006179 // Okay: we can take the address of a function.
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006180 // As above.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006181 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier() &&
6182 MD->isInstance())
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006183 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6184 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6185 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Steve Narofff633d092007-04-25 19:01:39 +00006186 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006187 }
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006188
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006189 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6190 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6191 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6192 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6193 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6194 }
6195
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006196 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006197 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006198}
6199
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006200QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006201 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6202 return Context.DependentTy;
6203
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006204 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
6205 QualType Ty = Op->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006206
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006207 // Note that per both C89 and C99, this is always legal, even if ptype is an
6208 // incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about dereferencing
6209 // a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a warning is
6210 // unlikely to catch any mistakes.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006211 if (const PointerType *PT = Ty->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006212 return PT->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006213
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006214 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
Fariborz Jahanianf15d4b62009-09-03 00:43:07 +00006215 return OPT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006216
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006217 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006218 << Ty << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006219 return QualType();
Steve Naroff1926c832007-04-24 00:23:05 +00006220}
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006221
6222static inline BinaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
6223 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6224 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6225 switch (Kind) {
6226 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006227 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemD; break;
6228 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemI; break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006229 case tok::star: Opc = BinaryOperator::Mul; break;
6230 case tok::slash: Opc = BinaryOperator::Div; break;
6231 case tok::percent: Opc = BinaryOperator::Rem; break;
6232 case tok::plus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Add; break;
6233 case tok::minus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Sub; break;
6234 case tok::lessless: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shl; break;
6235 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shr; break;
6236 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::LE; break;
6237 case tok::less: Opc = BinaryOperator::LT; break;
6238 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::GE; break;
6239 case tok::greater: Opc = BinaryOperator::GT; break;
6240 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::NE; break;
6241 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::EQ; break;
6242 case tok::amp: Opc = BinaryOperator::And; break;
6243 case tok::caret: Opc = BinaryOperator::Xor; break;
6244 case tok::pipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::Or; break;
6245 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BinaryOperator::LAnd; break;
6246 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::LOr; break;
6247 case tok::equal: Opc = BinaryOperator::Assign; break;
6248 case tok::starequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::MulAssign; break;
6249 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::DivAssign; break;
6250 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::RemAssign; break;
6251 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AddAssign; break;
6252 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::SubAssign; break;
6253 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShlAssign; break;
6254 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShrAssign; break;
6255 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AndAssign; break;
6256 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::XorAssign; break;
6257 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::OrAssign; break;
6258 case tok::comma: Opc = BinaryOperator::Comma; break;
6259 }
6260 return Opc;
6261}
6262
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006263static inline UnaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
6264 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6265 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6266 switch (Kind) {
6267 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
6268 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreInc; break;
6269 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreDec; break;
6270 case tok::amp: Opc = UnaryOperator::AddrOf; break;
6271 case tok::star: Opc = UnaryOperator::Deref; break;
6272 case tok::plus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Plus; break;
6273 case tok::minus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Minus; break;
6274 case tok::tilde: Opc = UnaryOperator::Not; break;
6275 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UnaryOperator::LNot; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006276 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UnaryOperator::Real; break;
6277 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UnaryOperator::Imag; break;
Chris Lattnerd0f76512007-06-08 22:16:53 +00006278 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UnaryOperator::Extension; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006279 }
6280 return Opc;
6281}
6282
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006283/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6284/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6285/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006286Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6287 unsigned Op,
6288 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006289 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006290 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)Op;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006291 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6292 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6293 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006294
6295 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006296 case BinaryOperator::Assign:
6297 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6298 break;
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006299 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemD:
6300 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemI:
6301 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
6302 Opc == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI);
6303 break;
6304 case BinaryOperator::Mul:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006305 case BinaryOperator::Div:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006306 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
6307 Opc == BinaryOperator::Div);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006308 break;
6309 case BinaryOperator::Rem:
6310 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6311 break;
6312 case BinaryOperator::Add:
6313 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6314 break;
6315 case BinaryOperator::Sub:
6316 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6317 break;
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006318 case BinaryOperator::Shl:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006319 case BinaryOperator::Shr:
6320 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6321 break;
6322 case BinaryOperator::LE:
6323 case BinaryOperator::LT:
6324 case BinaryOperator::GE:
6325 case BinaryOperator::GT:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006326 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006327 break;
6328 case BinaryOperator::EQ:
6329 case BinaryOperator::NE:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006330 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006331 break;
6332 case BinaryOperator::And:
6333 case BinaryOperator::Xor:
6334 case BinaryOperator::Or:
6335 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6336 break;
6337 case BinaryOperator::LAnd:
6338 case BinaryOperator::LOr:
6339 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6340 break;
6341 case BinaryOperator::MulAssign:
6342 case BinaryOperator::DivAssign:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006343 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
6344 Opc == BinaryOperator::DivAssign);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006345 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6346 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6347 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006348 break;
6349 case BinaryOperator::RemAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006350 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6351 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6352 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6353 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006354 break;
6355 case BinaryOperator::AddAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006356 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6357 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6358 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006359 break;
6360 case BinaryOperator::SubAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006361 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6362 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6363 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006364 break;
6365 case BinaryOperator::ShlAssign:
6366 case BinaryOperator::ShrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006367 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6368 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6369 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6370 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006371 break;
6372 case BinaryOperator::AndAssign:
6373 case BinaryOperator::XorAssign:
6374 case BinaryOperator::OrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006375 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6376 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6377 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6378 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006379 break;
6380 case BinaryOperator::Comma:
6381 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6382 break;
6383 }
6384 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006385 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006386 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006387 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6388 else
6389 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006390 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6391 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006392}
6393
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006394/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6395/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006396static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6397 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006398 SourceRange ParenRange,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006399 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondPD,
6400 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006401 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(ParenRange.getEnd());
6402 if (!ParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6403 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6404 // warning/error and return.
6405 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6406 return;
6407 }
6408
6409 Self.Diag(Loc, PD)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006410 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(ParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6411 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006412
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006413 if (!SecondPD.getDiagID())
6414 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006415
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006416 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6417 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6418 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6419 // warning/error and return.
6420 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondPD);
6421 return;
6422 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006423
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006424 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondPD)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006425 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6426 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006427}
6428
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006429/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6430/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6431/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6432/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006433static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6434 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006435 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6436 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6437 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6438 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006439 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006440 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006441 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6442
6443 // Subs are not binary operators.
6444 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6445 return;
6446
6447 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6448 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006449 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6450 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006451 return;
6452
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006453 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006454 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006455 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006456 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6457 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006458 lhs->getSourceRange(),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006459 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006460 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006461 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()));
6462 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006463 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006464 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006465 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6466 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006467 rhs->getSourceRange(),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006468 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006469 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006470 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()));
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006471}
6472
6473/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6474/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6475/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
6476static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6477 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006478 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006479 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6480}
6481
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006482// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006483Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
6484 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6485 ExprArg LHS, ExprArg RHS) {
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006486 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00006487 Expr *lhs = LHS.takeAs<Expr>(), *rhs = RHS.takeAs<Expr>();
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006488
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006489 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6490 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006491
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006492 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6493 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6494
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006495 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6496}
6497
6498Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6499 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6500 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006501 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006502 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006503 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6504 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6505 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6506 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6507 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006508 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006509 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006510 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6511 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6512 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006513
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006514 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6515 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006516 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006517 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006518
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006519 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006520 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006521}
6522
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006523Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006524 unsigned OpcIn,
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006525 ExprArg InputArg) {
6526 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006527
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006528 // FIXME: Input is modified below, but InputArg is not updated appropriately.
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006529 Expr *Input = (Expr *)InputArg.get();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006530 QualType resultType;
6531 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006532 case UnaryOperator::OffsetOf:
6533 assert(false && "Invalid unary operator");
6534 break;
6535
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006536 case UnaryOperator::PreInc:
6537 case UnaryOperator::PreDec:
Eli Friedman6aea5752009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006538 case UnaryOperator::PostInc:
6539 case UnaryOperator::PostDec:
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006540 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
Eli Friedman6aea5752009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006541 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
6542 Opc == UnaryOperator::PostInc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006543 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006544 case UnaryOperator::AddrOf:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006545 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006546 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006547 case UnaryOperator::Deref:
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006548 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006549 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006550 break;
6551 case UnaryOperator::Plus:
6552 case UnaryOperator::Minus:
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006553 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6554 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006555 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6556 break;
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006557 if (resultType->isArithmeticType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6558 break;
6559 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6560 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6561 break;
6562 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
6563 Opc == UnaryOperator::Plus &&
6564 resultType->isPointerType())
6565 break;
6566
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006567 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6568 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006569 case UnaryOperator::Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006570 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6571 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006572 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6573 break;
Chris Lattner0d707612008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006574 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
6575 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
6576 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006577 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006578 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner0d707612008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006579 else if (!resultType->isIntegerType())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006580 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6581 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006582 break;
6583 case UnaryOperator::LNot: // logical negation
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00006584 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006585 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006586 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006587 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6588 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006589 if (!resultType->isScalarType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006590 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6591 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattnerbe31ed82007-06-02 19:11:33 +00006592 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006593 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
6594 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006595 break;
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006596 case UnaryOperator::Real:
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006597 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00006598 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UnaryOperator::Real);
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006599 break;
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006600 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006601 resultType = Input->getType();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00006602 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006603 }
6604 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006605 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006606
6607 InputArg.release();
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006608 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006609}
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006610
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006611Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6612 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6613 ExprArg input) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006614 Expr *Input = (Expr*)input.get();
Anders Carlsson461a2c02009-11-14 21:26:41 +00006615 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
6616 Opc != UnaryOperator::Extension) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006617 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6618 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6619 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6620 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006621 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006622 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006623 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6624 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
6625 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006626
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006627 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, move(input));
6628 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006629
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006630 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, move(input));
6631}
6632
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006633// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
6634Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6635 tok::TokenKind Op, ExprArg input) {
6636 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), move(input));
6637}
6638
Steve Naroff66356bd2007-09-16 14:56:35 +00006639/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006640Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6641 SourceLocation LabLoc,
6642 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006643 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
Chris Lattner3318e862009-04-18 20:01:55 +00006644 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getLabelMap()[LabelII];
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006645
Daniel Dunbar88402ce2008-08-04 16:51:22 +00006646 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
6647 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroff846b1ec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00006648 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006649 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006650
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006651 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006652 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
6653 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006654}
6655
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006656Sema::OwningExprResult
6657Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, StmtArg substmt,
6658 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
6659 Stmt *SubStmt = static_cast<Stmt*>(substmt.get());
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006660 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
6661 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
6662
Douglas Gregor6cf3f3c2010-03-10 04:54:39 +00006663 bool isFileScope
6664 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattnera69b0762009-04-25 19:11:05 +00006665 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006666 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedman52cc0162009-01-24 23:09:00 +00006667
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006668 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
6669 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
6670 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006671
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006672 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
6673 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
6674 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006675
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006676 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
6677 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
6678 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
6679 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt))
6680 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006681
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006682 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt))
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006683 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006684 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006685
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006686 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
6687 // expressions are not lvalues.
6688
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006689 substmt.release();
6690 return Owned(new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc));
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006691}
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006692
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006693Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
6694 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6695 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
6696 TypeTy *argty,
6697 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6698 unsigned NumComponents,
6699 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
6700 // FIXME: This function leaks all expressions in the offset components on
6701 // error.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc7148c92009-08-19 01:28:28 +00006702 // FIXME: Preserve type source info.
6703 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty);
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006704 assert(!ArgTy.isNull() && "Missing type argument!");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006705
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006706 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
6707
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006708 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6709 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6710 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006711 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006712 return ExprError(Diag(TypeLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type) << ArgTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006713
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006714 // FIXME: Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6715 // with an incomplete type would be illegal.
Douglas Gregor26897462009-03-11 16:48:53 +00006716
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006717 // Otherwise, create a null pointer as the base, and iteratively process
6718 // the offsetof designators.
6719 QualType ArgTyPtr = Context.getPointerType(ArgTy);
6720 Expr* Res = new (Context) ImplicitValueInitExpr(ArgTyPtr);
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006721 Res = new (Context) UnaryOperator(Res, UnaryOperator::Deref,
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006722 ArgTy, SourceLocation());
Eli Friedman16c88df2009-01-26 01:33:06 +00006723
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006724 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6725 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006726 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6727 // a system header!
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006728 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006729 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6730 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006731
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006732 if (!Dependent) {
Eli Friedman8469bc72009-05-03 21:22:18 +00006733 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006734
John McCall9eff4e62009-11-04 03:03:43 +00006735 if (RequireCompleteType(TypeLoc, Res->getType(),
6736 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6737 return ExprError();
6738
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006739 // FIXME: Dependent case loses a lot of information here. And probably
6740 // leaks like a sieve.
6741 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6742 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6743 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6744 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6745 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(Res->getType());
6746 if (!AT) {
6747 Res->Destroy(Context);
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006748 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
6749 << Res->getType());
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006750 }
6751
6752 // FIXME: C++: Verify that operator[] isn't overloaded.
6753
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006754 // Promote the array so it looks more like a normal array subscript
6755 // expression.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006756 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Res);
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006757
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006758 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
6759 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006760 // FIXME: Leaks Res
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006761 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006762 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00006763 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006764 << Idx->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006765
6766 Res = new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(Res, Idx, AT->getElementType(),
6767 OC.LocEnd);
6768 continue;
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006769 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006770
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006771 const RecordType *RC = Res->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006772 if (!RC) {
6773 Res->Destroy(Context);
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006774 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6775 << Res->getType());
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006776 }
Chris Lattner98dbf0a2007-08-30 17:59:59 +00006777
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006778 // Get the decl corresponding to this.
6779 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
Anders Carlsson2bbb86b2009-05-01 23:20:30 +00006780 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00006781 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6782 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6783 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
6784 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6785 << Res->getType()))
6786 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
Anders Carlsson2bbb86b2009-05-01 23:20:30 +00006787 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006788
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +00006789 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
6790 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
John McCall9f3059a2009-10-09 21:13:30 +00006791
John McCall67c00872009-12-02 08:25:40 +00006792 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006793 // FIXME: Leaks Res
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006794 if (!MemberDecl)
Douglas Gregore40876a2009-10-13 21:16:44 +00006795 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
6796 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart, OC.LocEnd));
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006797
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006798 // FIXME: C++: Verify that MemberDecl isn't a static field.
6799 // FIXME: Verify that MemberDecl isn't a bitfield.
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006800 if (cast<RecordDecl>(MemberDecl->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
Anders Carlsson3cbc8592009-05-01 19:30:39 +00006801 Res = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(
John McCall7e1d6d72009-11-11 03:23:23 +00006802 OC.LocEnd, MemberDecl, Res, OC.LocEnd).takeAs<Expr>();
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006803 } else {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00006804 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Res, /*Qualifier=*/0,
6805 *R.begin(), MemberDecl);
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006806 // MemberDecl->getType() doesn't get the right qualifiers, but it
6807 // doesn't matter here.
6808 Res = new (Context) MemberExpr(Res, false, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd,
6809 MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType());
6810 }
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006811 }
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006812 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006813
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006814 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Res, UnaryOperator::OffsetOf,
6815 Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc));
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006816}
6817
6818
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006819Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6820 TypeTy *arg1,TypeTy *arg2,
6821 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc7148c92009-08-19 01:28:28 +00006822 // FIXME: Preserve type source info.
6823 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1);
6824 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006825
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006826 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006827
Douglas Gregorf907cbf2009-05-19 22:28:02 +00006828 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6829 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
6830 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
6831 return ExprError();
6832 }
6833
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006834 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
6835 argT1, argT2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006836}
6837
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006838Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6839 ExprArg cond,
6840 ExprArg expr1, ExprArg expr2,
6841 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
6842 Expr *CondExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(cond.get());
6843 Expr *LHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr1.get());
6844 Expr *RHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr2.get());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006845
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00006846 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
6847
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006848 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006849 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregor0df91122009-05-19 22:43:30 +00006850 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006851 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006852 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006853 } else {
6854 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
6855 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
6856 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
6857 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006858 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
6859 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
6860 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00006861
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006862 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
6863 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006864 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
6865 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006866 }
6867
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006868 cond.release(); expr1.release(); expr2.release();
6869 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006870 resType, RPLoc,
6871 resType->isDependentType(),
6872 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00006873}
6874
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00006875//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6876// Clang Extensions.
6877//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6878
6879/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00006880void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00006881 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
6882 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
6883 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
6884 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00006885}
6886
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00006887void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00006888 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00006889 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006890
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00006891 if (ParamInfo.getNumTypeObjects() == 0
6892 || ParamInfo.getTypeObject(0).Kind != DeclaratorChunk::Function) {
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00006893 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00006894 QualType T = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
6895
Mike Stumpd456c482009-04-28 01:10:27 +00006896 if (T->isArrayType()) {
6897 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
6898 diag::err_block_returns_array);
6899 return;
6900 }
6901
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00006902 // The parameter list is optional, if there was none, assume ().
6903 if (!T->isFunctionType())
Rafael Espindolac50c27c2010-03-30 20:24:48 +00006904 T = Context.getFunctionType(T, 0, 0, false, 0, false, false, 0, 0,
6905 FunctionType::ExtInfo());
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00006906
6907 CurBlock->hasPrototype = true;
6908 CurBlock->isVariadic = false;
Fariborz Jahanian6607b212009-05-14 20:53:39 +00006909 // Check for a valid sentinel attribute on this block.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00006910 if (CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006911 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
Fariborz Jahanian6802ed92009-05-15 21:18:04 +00006912 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
Fariborz Jahanian6607b212009-05-14 20:53:39 +00006913 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
6914 }
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006915 QualType RetTy = T.getTypePtr()->getAs<FunctionType>()->getResultType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006916
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00006917 // Do not allow returning a objc interface by-value.
6918 if (RetTy->isObjCInterfaceType()) {
6919 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
6920 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
6921 return;
6922 }
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006923
6924 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00006925 return;
6926 }
6927
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00006928 // Analyze arguments to block.
6929 assert(ParamInfo.getTypeObject(0).Kind == DeclaratorChunk::Function &&
6930 "Not a function declarator!");
6931 DeclaratorChunk::FunctionTypeInfo &FTI = ParamInfo.getTypeObject(0).Fun;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006932
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00006933 CurBlock->hasPrototype = FTI.hasPrototype;
6934 CurBlock->isVariadic = true;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006935
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00006936 // Check for C99 6.7.5.3p10 - foo(void) is a non-varargs function that takes
6937 // no arguments, not a function that takes a single void argument.
6938 if (FTI.hasPrototype &&
6939 FTI.NumArgs == 1 && !FTI.isVariadic && FTI.ArgInfo[0].Ident == 0 &&
Chris Lattner83f095c2009-03-28 19:18:32 +00006940 (!FTI.ArgInfo[0].Param.getAs<ParmVarDecl>()->getType().getCVRQualifiers()&&
6941 FTI.ArgInfo[0].Param.getAs<ParmVarDecl>()->getType()->isVoidType())) {
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00006942 // empty arg list, don't push any params.
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00006943 CurBlock->isVariadic = false;
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00006944 } else if (FTI.hasPrototype) {
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00006945 for (unsigned i = 0, e = FTI.NumArgs; i != e; ++i) {
6946 ParmVarDecl *Param = FTI.ArgInfo[i].Param.getAs<ParmVarDecl>();
6947 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
6948 !Param->isImplicit() &&
6949 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
6950 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
6951 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
6952 CurBlock->Params.push_back(Param);
6953 }
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00006954 CurBlock->isVariadic = FTI.isVariadic;
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00006955 }
Douglas Gregord5058122010-02-11 01:19:42 +00006956 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(CurBlock->Params.data(),
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00006957 CurBlock->Params.size());
Fariborz Jahanian960910a2009-05-19 17:08:59 +00006958 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(CurBlock->isVariadic);
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00006959 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00006960
6961 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
6962 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
6963
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00006964 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00006965 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
6966 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
6967
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00006968 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00006969 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
6970 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
6971 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
6972
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00006973 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00006974 }
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00006975 }
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00006976
Fariborz Jahanian6607b212009-05-14 20:53:39 +00006977 // Check for a valid sentinel attribute on this block.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006978 if (!CurBlock->isVariadic &&
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00006979 CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006980 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
Fariborz Jahanian6802ed92009-05-15 21:18:04 +00006981 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
Fariborz Jahanian6607b212009-05-14 20:53:39 +00006982 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
6983 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006984
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00006985 // Analyze the return type.
6986 QualType T = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006987 QualType RetTy = T->getAs<FunctionType>()->getResultType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006988
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00006989 // Do not allow returning a objc interface by-value.
6990 if (RetTy->isObjCInterfaceType()) {
6991 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
6992 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
6993 } else if (!RetTy->isDependentType())
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00006994 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00006995}
6996
6997/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
6998/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
6999void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007000 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner41b86942009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007001 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007002 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007003 // FIXME: Delete the ParmVarDecl objects as well???
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007004}
7005
7006/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7007/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007008Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
7009 StmtArg body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9eac9312009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007010 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7011 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7012 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007013
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007014 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007015
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007016 PopDeclContext();
7017
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007018 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007019 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7020 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007021
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007022 llvm::SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes;
7023 for (unsigned i = 0, e = BSI->Params.size(); i != e; ++i)
7024 ArgTypes.push_back(BSI->Params[i]->getType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007025
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007026 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007027 QualType BlockTy;
7028 if (!BSI->hasPrototype)
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007029 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0, false, false, 0, 0,
Rafael Espindola49b85ab2010-03-30 22:15:11 +00007030 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007031 else
Jay Foad7d0479f2009-05-21 09:52:38 +00007032 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, ArgTypes.data(), ArgTypes.size(),
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007033 BSI->isVariadic, 0, false, false, 0, 0,
Rafael Espindola49b85ab2010-03-30 22:15:11 +00007034 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007035
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007036 // FIXME: Check that return/parameter types are complete/non-abstract
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007037 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->Params.begin(), BSI->Params.end());
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007038 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007039
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007040 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007041 if (FunctionNeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007042 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(static_cast<CompoundStmt*>(body.get()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007043
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00007044 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(body.takeAs<CompoundStmt>());
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007045
7046 bool Good = true;
7047 // Check goto/label use.
7048 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7049 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7050 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7051
7052 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7053 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
7054 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0)
7055 continue;
7056
7057 // Emit error.
7058 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7059 Good = false;
7060 }
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007061 if (!Good) {
7062 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007063 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007064 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007065
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007066 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenek0b405322010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007067 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7068 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
7069 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy);
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007070
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007071 Expr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7072 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007073 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007074 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007075}
7076
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007077Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7078 ExprArg expr, TypeTy *type,
7079 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc7148c92009-08-19 01:28:28 +00007080 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type);
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007081 Expr *E = static_cast<Expr*>(expr.get());
7082 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007083
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007084 InitBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007085
7086 // Get the va_list type
7087 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007088 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7089 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7090 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7091 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007092 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007093 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7094 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7095 } else {
7096 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7097 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007098 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007099 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007100 return ExprError();
7101 }
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007102
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007103 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7104 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007105 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7106 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007107 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner3f5cd772009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007108 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007109
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007110 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007111 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007112
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007113 expr.release();
7114 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, T.getNonReferenceType(),
7115 RPLoc));
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007116}
7117
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007118Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007119 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7120 // pointers on the target.
7121 QualType Ty;
7122 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7123 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7124 else
7125 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7126
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007127 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007128}
7129
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007130static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
7131 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007132 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7133 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007134
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007135 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7136 if (!PT)
7137 return;
7138
7139 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7140 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7141 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7142 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7143 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7144 return;
7145 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007146
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007147 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7148 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7149 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7150 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007151
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007152 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007153}
7154
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007155bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7156 SourceLocation Loc,
7157 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00007158 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action) {
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007159 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7160 bool isInvalid = false;
7161 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007162 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007163
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007164 switch (ConvTy) {
7165 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7166 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007167 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007168 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7169 break;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007170 case IntToPointer:
7171 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7172 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007173 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007174 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007175 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7176 break;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007177 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7178 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7179 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007180 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7181 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7182 break;
7183 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007184 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7185 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7186 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7187 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7188 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7189 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7190 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7191 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7192 // C++ semantics.
7193 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7194 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7195 return false;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007196 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7197 break;
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007198 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanianb98dade2009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007199 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007200 break;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007201 case IntToBlockPointer:
7202 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7203 break;
7204 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stumpd79b5a82009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007205 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007206 break;
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007207 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007208 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007209 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7210 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7211 break;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007212 case IncompatibleVectors:
7213 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7214 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007215 case Incompatible:
7216 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7217 isInvalid = true;
7218 break;
7219 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007220
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00007221 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << DstType << SrcType << Action
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007222 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007223 return isInvalid;
7224}
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007225
Chris Lattnerc71d08b2009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007226bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007227 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7228 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7229 if (Result)
7230 *Result = ICEResult;
7231 return false;
7232 }
7233
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007234 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7235
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007236 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007237 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7238 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7239
7240 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7241 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7242 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7243 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7244 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7245 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7246 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007247
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007248 return true;
7249 }
7250
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007251 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7252 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007253
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007254 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7255 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7256 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007257
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007258 if (Result)
7259 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7260 return false;
7261}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007262
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007263void
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007264Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007265 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7266 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007267}
7268
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007269void
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007270Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7271 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7272 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7273 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007274
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007275 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7276 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7277 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7278 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7279 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007280 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007281 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7282 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7283 I != IEnd; ++I)
7284 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7285 }
7286
7287 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7288 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7289 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7290 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7291 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7292 I != IEnd; ++I)
7293 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7294 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007295 }
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007296
7297 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7298 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7299 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7300 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007301 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007302 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7303 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7304 ExprTemporaries.end());
7305
7306 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7307 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007308}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007309
7310/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7311///
7312/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7313/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7314/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7315/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7316///
7317/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7318///
7319/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7320void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7321 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007322
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007323 if (D->isUsed())
7324 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007325
Douglas Gregor3beaf9b2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007326 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7327 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7328 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7329 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007330 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregor3beaf9b2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007331 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()))
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007332 D->setUsed(true);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007333
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007334 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7335 // an instantiation.
7336 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7337 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007338
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007339 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007340 case Unevaluated:
7341 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7342 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007343
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007344 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7345 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7346 // "used"; handle this below.
7347 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007348
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007349 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7350 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7351 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7352 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007353 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007354 return;
7355 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007356
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007357 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanian3a363432009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007358 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007359 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian18eb69a2009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007360 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
7361 if (!Constructor->isUsed())
7362 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007363 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor507eb872009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007364 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007365 if (!Constructor->isUsed())
7366 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7367 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007368
Anders Carlsson82fccd02009-12-07 08:24:59 +00007369 MaybeMarkVirtualMembersReferenced(Loc, Constructor);
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007370 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
7371 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed())
7372 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007373
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007374 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7375 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7376 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
7377 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed())
7378 DefineImplicitOverloadedAssign(Loc, MethodDecl);
7379 }
7380 }
Fariborz Jahanian49796cc72009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007381 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007382 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor4adbc6d2009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007383 // class templates.
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007384 if (!Function->getBody() && Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007385 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7386 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7387 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7388 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7389 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007390 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007391 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007392 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007393 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007394 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7395 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7396 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007397 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007398 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007399 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7400 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007401
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007402 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7403 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
7404 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
7405 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
7406 Loc));
7407 else
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007408 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007409 Loc));
7410 }
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007411 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007412
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007413 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007414 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007415
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007416 return;
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007417 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007418
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007419 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007420 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007421 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007422 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
7423 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
7424 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
7425 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
7426 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
7427 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
7428 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
7429 }
7430 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007431
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007432 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007433
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007434 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007435 return;
Sam Weinigbae69142009-09-11 03:29:30 +00007436 }
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007437}
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007438
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007439/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
7440/// of the program being compiled.
7441///
7442/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007443/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007444/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
7445/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
7446/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
7447/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007448/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007449/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007450///
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007451/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
7452/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
7453/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
7454/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007455bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007456 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
7457 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
7458 case Unevaluated:
7459 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
7460 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007461
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007462 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7463 Diag(Loc, PD);
7464 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007465
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007466 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7467 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
7468 break;
7469 }
7470
7471 return false;
7472}
7473
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007474bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
7475 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
7476 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
7477 return false;
7478
7479 PartialDiagnostic Note =
7480 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
7481 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
7482 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007483
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007484 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007485 FD ?
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007486 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
7487 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007488 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007489 << CE->getSourceRange(),
7490 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
7491 return true;
7492
7493 return false;
7494}
7495
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007496// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
7497// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
7498void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
7499 SourceLocation Loc;
7500
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007501 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
7502
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007503 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
7504 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
7505 if (Op->getOpcode() != BinaryOperator::Assign)
7506 return;
7507
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007508 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
7509 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
7510 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
7511 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
7512
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007513 // self = [<foo> init...]
7514 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
7515 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
7516 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7517
7518 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
7519 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
7520 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
7521 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7522 }
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007523
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007524 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7525 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
7526 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
7527 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
7528 return;
7529
7530 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7531 } else {
7532 // Not an assignment.
7533 return;
7534 }
7535
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007536 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCalle724ae92009-10-12 22:25:59 +00007537 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007538
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007539 Diag(Loc, diagnostic)
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007540 << E->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007541 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
7542 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007543 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007544 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007545}
7546
7547bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
7548 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
7549
7550 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007551 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007552
7553 QualType T = E->getType();
7554
7555 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7556 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
7557 return true;
7558 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
7559 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
7560 << T << E->getSourceRange();
7561 return true;
7562 }
7563 }
7564
7565 return false;
7566}